Update copyright years.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380 The default value of this macro is empty string.
381 @end defmac
382
383 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391 @end defmac
392
393 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395 @end deftypevr
396
397 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406 @xref{Target Fragment}.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412 indicates an absolute file name.
413 @end defmac
414
415 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418 when the compiler is built as a cross
419 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421 @end defmac
422
423 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428 is built as a cross compiler.
429 @end defmac
430
431 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436 is built as a cross compiler.
437 @end defmac
438
439 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444 is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456 cross compiler.
457 @end defmac
458
459 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463 initialize the necessary environment variables.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481 @end defmac
482
483 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
491 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496 for C++-only directories,
497 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499 the array with a null element.
500
501 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508 @smallexample
509 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ \
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
516 @}
517 @end smallexample
518 @end defmac
519
520 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522 @enumerate
523 @item
524 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526 @item
527 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531 @item
532 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534 @item
535 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544 @item
545 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546 compiler.
547 @end enumerate
548
549 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551 @enumerate
552 @item
553 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555 @item
556 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557 value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572 compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/lib/}.
591
592 @item
593 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595 @file{/usr/lib/}.
596 @end enumerate
597
598 @node Run-time Target
599 @section Run-time Target Specification
600 @cindex run-time target specification
601 @cindex predefined macros
602 @cindex target specifications
603
604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
605 Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
612 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613 finished command line option processing your code can use those
614 results freely.
615
616 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
624 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640 preprocessing.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target operating system instead.
646 @end defmac
647
648 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652 it yourself.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657 any target-specific headers.
658 @end deftypevar
659
660 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662 Its default setting is 0.
663 @end deftypevr
664
665 @cindex optional hardware or system features
666 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673 definition does nothing but return true.
674
675 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679 via attributes).
680 @end deftypefn
681
682 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688 default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714 @end deftypefn
715
716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724 @end deftypefn
725
726 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728 but is only used in the C
729 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731 frontends.
732 @end defmac
733
734 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738 options are processed once
739 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741 options passed explicitly.
742
743 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745 @code{optimize} attribute.
746 @end deftypevr
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754 @end deftypefn
755
756 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772 is 0.
773 @end defmac
774
775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777 @end deftypefn
778
779 @node Per-Function Data
780 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781 @cindex per-function data
782 @cindex data structures
783
784 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788 when another one comes along.
789
790 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794 to their own specific data.
795
796 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
800
801 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804 function, for level 0.
805
806 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
811 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814 longer supported.
815
816 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
818 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821 @end defmac
822
823 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833 @end deftypevar
834
835 @node Storage Layout
836 @section Storage Layout
837 @cindex storage layout
838
839 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842 @xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850 macro need not be a constant.
851
852 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
864 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
866 macro need not be a constant.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873 the order of words in memory.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883 multi-word integers.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906 @end defmac
907
908 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925 @end defmac
926
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931 scalar type.
932
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938 counterparts.
939
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
951 Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
952 @end deftypefn
953
954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
955 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
956 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
957 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
958 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
959 pointer} types.
960
961 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
962 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
963 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
964 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
965 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
966 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
967 the signedness may be different.
968
969 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
970
971 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
972 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
973 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
974 @end deftypefn
975
976 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
977 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
978 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
979 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
980 size of an integer.
981 @end defmac
982
983 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
984 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
985 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
986 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
987 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
988 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
989 @end defmac
990
991 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
992 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
993 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
994 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
995 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
996 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1000 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1001 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1002 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1003 @end defmac
1004
1005 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1006 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1010 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1011 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1012 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1013 @end defmac
1014
1015 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1016 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1017 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1018 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1019 @end deftypevr
1020
1021 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1022 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1023 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1024 @end defmac
1025
1026 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1027 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1028 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1029 @end defmac
1030
1031 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1032 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1033 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1034 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1035 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1036 @end defmac
1037
1038 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1039 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1040 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1041 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1042 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1043 @end defmac
1044
1045 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1046 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1047 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1048 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1049 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1050 field alignment has not been set by the
1051 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1052 @end defmac
1053
1054 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1055 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1056 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1057
1058 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1059
1060 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1061 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1062 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1063 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1064 @end defmac
1065
1066 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1067 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1068 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1069 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1070 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1071
1072 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1073 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1074 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1075 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1076 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1077 @end defmac
1078
1079 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1080 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1081 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1082 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1083 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1084
1085 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1086
1087 @findex strcpy
1088 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1089 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1090 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1091 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1092 @end defmac
1093
1094 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1095 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1096 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1097 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1098 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1099
1100 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1101 @end defmac
1102
1103 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1104 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1105 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1106 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1107 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1108 align the object.
1109
1110 The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
1111
1112 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1113 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1114 constants can be done inline.
1115 @end defmac
1116
1117 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1118 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1119 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1120 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1121 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1122
1123 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1124
1125 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1126 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1127
1128 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1129 @end defmac
1130
1131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1132 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1133 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1134 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1135 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1136 the vector element type.
1137 @end deftypefn
1138
1139 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1140 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1141 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1142 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1143 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1144 align the slot.
1145
1146 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1147 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1148 be used.
1149
1150 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1151 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1152
1153 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1154 @end defmac
1155
1156 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1157 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1158 variable @var{decl}.
1159
1160 If this macro is not defined, then
1161 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1162 is used.
1163
1164 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1165 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1166
1167 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1168 @end defmac
1169
1170 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1171 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1172 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1173 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1174
1175 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1176 @end defmac
1177
1178 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1179 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1180 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1181
1182 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1183 @end defmac
1184
1185 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1186 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1187 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1188
1189 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1190 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1191 @end defmac
1192
1193 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1194 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1195 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1196 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1197 @end defmac
1198
1199 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1200 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1201 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1202
1203 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1204 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1205 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1206 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1207 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1208
1209 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1210 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1211 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1212 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1213
1214 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1215 structure.
1216
1217 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1218 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1219
1220 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1221 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1222 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1223 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1224
1225 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1226 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1227 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1228
1229 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1230 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1231 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1232
1233 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1234 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1235 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1236
1237 @smallexample
1238 struct foo1
1239 @{
1240 char x;
1241 char :0;
1242 char y;
1243 @};
1244
1245 struct foo2
1246 @{
1247 char x;
1248 int :0;
1249 char y;
1250 @};
1251
1252 main ()
1253 @{
1254 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1255 sizeof (struct foo1));
1256 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1257 sizeof (struct foo2));
1258 exit (0);
1259 @}
1260 @end smallexample
1261
1262 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1263 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1264 @end defmac
1265
1266 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1267 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1268 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1269 @end defmac
1270
1271 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1272 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1273 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1274 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1275 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1276 @end deftypefn
1277
1278 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1279 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1280 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1281 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1282
1283 The default is @code{false}.
1284 @end deftypefn
1285
1286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1287 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1288 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1289
1290 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1291 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1292 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1293 retain the field's mode.
1294
1295 Normally, this is not needed.
1296 @end deftypefn
1297
1298 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1299 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1300 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1301 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1302 @var{specified}.
1303
1304 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1305 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1306 @end defmac
1307
1308 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1309 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1310 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1311 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1312 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1313 (DImode)} is assumed.
1314 @end defmac
1315
1316 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1317 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1318 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1319 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1320 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1321 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1322 having its mode specified.
1323
1324 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1325 would most commonly define this macro if the
1326 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1327 64-bit mode.
1328 @end defmac
1329
1330 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1331 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1332 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1333 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1334
1335 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1336 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1337 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1338 @end defmac
1339
1340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1341 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1342 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1343 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1344 targets.
1345 @end deftypefn
1346
1347 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1348 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1349 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1350 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1351 targets.
1352 @end deftypefn
1353
1354 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1355 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1356 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1357 @end deftypefn
1358
1359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1360 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1361 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1362 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1363 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1364 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1365 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1366 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1367 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1368 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1369 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1370 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1371
1372 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1373 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1374 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1375 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1376 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1377 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1378 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1379
1380 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1381 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1382 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1383 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1384 may affect its placement.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1392 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1396 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1397 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1398 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1399 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1400 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1401 usage.
1402 @end deftypefn
1403
1404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1405 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1406 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1407 @end deftypefn
1408
1409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1410 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1411 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1412 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1413 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1414 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1415 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1416 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1417 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1418 string constant.
1419
1420 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1421 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1422 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1423 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1424 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1425 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1426 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1427 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1428 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1429 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1430 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1431 spaces in your string.
1432
1433 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1434 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1435 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1436 before mangling.
1437
1438 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1439 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1440 types.
1441 @end deftypefn
1442
1443 @node Type Layout
1444 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1445
1446 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1447 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1448 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1449 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1450
1451 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1452 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1453 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1454 @end defmac
1455
1456 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1457 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1458 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1459 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1460 unit.)
1461 @end defmac
1462
1463 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1465 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1466 @end defmac
1467
1468 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1469 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1470 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1471 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1472 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1473 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1474 @end defmac
1475
1476 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1477 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1478 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1479 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1480 macro must be at least 64.
1481 @end defmac
1482
1483 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1484 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1485 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1486 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1487 @end defmac
1488
1489 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1490 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1491 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1492 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1493 @end defmac
1494
1495 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1496 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1497 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1498 @end defmac
1499
1500 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503 words.
1504 @end defmac
1505
1506 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1508 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509 words.
1510 @end defmac
1511
1512 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1514 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1516 @end defmac
1517
1518 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1519 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1520 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1522 @end defmac
1523
1524 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1526 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1528 @end defmac
1529
1530 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1534 @end defmac
1535
1536 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1540 @end defmac
1541
1542 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1546 @end defmac
1547
1548 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1555 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1556 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1561 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1562 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1563 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1564 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1565 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1566 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1567 @end defmac
1568
1569 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1570 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1571 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1572 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1573 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1574 is the default.
1575 @end defmac
1576
1577 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1578 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1579 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1580 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1581 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1582 @end defmac
1583
1584 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1585 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1586 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1587 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1588 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1589
1590 The default is to return false.
1591 @end deftypefn
1592
1593 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1594 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1595 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1596 contents of the string.
1597
1598 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1599 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1600 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1601 of the data type names defined in the function
1602 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1603 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1604 compiler to crash on startup.
1605
1606 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1607 int"}.
1608 @end defmac
1609
1610 @defmac SIZETYPE
1611 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1612 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1613 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1614 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1615 is extracted.
1616
1617 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1618
1619 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1620 @end defmac
1621
1622 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1623 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1625 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1626 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1627
1628 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1629 @end defmac
1630
1631 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1632 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1633 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1634 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1635 information.
1636
1637 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1638 @end defmac
1639
1640 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1641 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1642 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1643 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1644 @end defmac
1645
1646 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1647 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1648 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1649 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1650 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1651 information.
1652
1653 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1654 @end defmac
1655
1656 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1657 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1658 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1659 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1660 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1661
1662 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1663 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1664 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1665 @end defmac
1666
1667 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1668 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1669 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1670 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1671 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1672
1673 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1674 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1675 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1676 int}.
1677 @end defmac
1678
1679 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1680 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1681 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1682 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1683 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1684 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1685 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1686 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1687 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1688 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1689 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1690 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1691 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1692 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1693 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1694 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1695 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1696 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1697 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1698 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1700 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1701 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1702 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1706 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1707 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1708 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1709 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1710 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1711 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1712 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1713 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1714 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1715 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1716
1717 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1718 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1719 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1720 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1721 these macros are null pointers.
1722 @end defmac
1723
1724 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1725 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1726 that looks like:
1727
1728 @smallexample
1729 struct @{
1730 union @{
1731 void (*fn)();
1732 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1733 @};
1734 ptrdiff_t delta;
1735 @};
1736 @end smallexample
1737
1738 @noindent
1739 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1740 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1741 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1742 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1743 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1744 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1745 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1746 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1747
1748 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1749 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1750 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1751 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1752 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1753 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1754 architecture, you should define this macro to
1755 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1756
1757 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1758 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1759 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1760 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1761 @end defmac
1762
1763 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1764 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1765 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1766 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1767 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1768 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1769 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1770
1771 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1772 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1773 @end defmac
1774
1775 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1776 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1777 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1778 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1779 when special alignment is necessary. */
1780 @end defmac
1781
1782 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1783 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1784 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1785 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1786 of words in each data entry.
1787 @end defmac
1788
1789 @node Registers
1790 @section Register Usage
1791 @cindex register usage
1792
1793 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1794 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1795
1796 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1797 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1798 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1799 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1800 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1801
1802 @menu
1803 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1804 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1805 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1806 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1807 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1808 @end menu
1809
1810 @node Register Basics
1811 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1812
1813 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1814 Registers have various characteristics.
1815
1816 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1817 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1818 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1819 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1820 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1821 @end defmac
1822
1823 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1824 @cindex fixed register
1825 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1826 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1827 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1828 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1829 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1830 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1831 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1832
1833 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1834 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1835 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1836
1837 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1838 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1839 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1840 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1841 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1842 @end defmac
1843
1844 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1845 @cindex call-used register
1846 @cindex call-clobbered register
1847 @cindex call-saved register
1848 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1849 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1850 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1851 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1852 function calls.
1853
1854 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1855 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1856 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1857 @end defmac
1858
1859 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1860 @cindex call-used register
1861 @cindex call-clobbered register
1862 @cindex call-saved register
1863 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1864 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1865 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1866 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1867 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1868 @end defmac
1869
1870 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1871 @cindex call-used register
1872 @cindex call-clobbered register
1873 @cindex call-saved register
1874 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1875 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1876 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1877 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1878 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1879 @end defmac
1880
1881 @findex fixed_regs
1882 @findex call_used_regs
1883 @findex global_regs
1884 @findex reg_names
1885 @findex reg_class_contents
1886 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1887 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1888 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1889 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1890 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1891 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1892 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1893 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1894 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1895 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1896 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1897 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1898 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1899 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1900 command options have been applied.
1901
1902 @cindex disabling certain registers
1903 @cindex controlling register usage
1904 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1905 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1906 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1907 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1908 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1909 that shouldn't be used.
1910
1911 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1912 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1913 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1914 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1915 @end deftypefn
1916
1917 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1918 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1919 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1920 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1921 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1922 outbound register.
1923 @end defmac
1924
1925 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1926 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1927 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1928 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1929 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1930 register.
1931 @end defmac
1932
1933 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1934 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1935 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1936 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1937 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1938 gotos.
1939 @end defmac
1940
1941 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1942 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1943 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1944 @end defmac
1945
1946 @node Allocation Order
1947 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1948 @cindex order of register allocation
1949 @cindex register allocation order
1950
1951 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1952 Registers are allocated in order.
1953
1954 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1955 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1956 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1957 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1958
1959 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1960 (all else being equal).
1961
1962 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1963 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1964 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1965 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1966 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1967 @end defmac
1968
1969 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1970 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1971 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1972
1973 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1974 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1975 register; and so on.
1976
1977 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1978 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1979
1980 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1981 @end defmac
1982
1983 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1984 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1985 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1986 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1987 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1988 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1989 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1990 @end defmac
1991
1992 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1993 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1994 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1995 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1996 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1997 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
1998 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
1999 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2000
2001 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2002 @end defmac
2003
2004 @node Values in Registers
2005 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2006
2007 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2008 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2009 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2010
2011 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2012 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2013 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2014 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2015 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2016 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2017
2018 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2019 definition of this macro is
2020
2021 @smallexample
2022 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2023 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2024 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2025 @end smallexample
2026 @end defmac
2027
2028 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2029 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2030 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2031 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2032 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2033 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2034 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2035
2036 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2037 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2038 nonzero.
2039
2040 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2041 @code{subreg_get_info}
2042 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2043 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2044 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2045 registers and so not be representable.
2046 @end defmac
2047
2048 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2049 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2050 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2051 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2052 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2053 @end defmac
2054
2055 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2056 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2057 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2058 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2059 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2060 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2061 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2062 @end defmac
2063
2064 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2065 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2066 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2067 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2068 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2069
2070 @smallexample
2071 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2075 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2076
2077 @cindex register pairs
2078 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2079 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2080 odd register numbers for such modes.
2081
2082 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2083 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2084 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2085 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2086
2087 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2088 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2089 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2090 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2091 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2092 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2093 to be tieable.
2094
2095 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2096 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2097 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2098 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2099 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2100 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2101
2102 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2103 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2104 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2105 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2106 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2107 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2108 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2109 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2110 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2111
2112 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2113 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2114 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2115 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2116 constraints for those instructions.
2117
2118 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2119 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2120 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2121 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2122 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2123 @end defmac
2124
2125 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2126 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2127 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2128
2129 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2130 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2131 handler.
2132
2133 The default is always nonzero.
2134 @end defmac
2135
2136 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2137 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2138 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2139
2140 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2141 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2142 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2143 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2144 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2145 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2146
2147 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2148 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2149 allocation.
2150 @end defmac
2151
2152 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2153 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2154 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2155
2156 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2157 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2158
2159 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2160 @end deftypefn
2161
2162 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2163 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2164 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2165 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2166 @end defmac
2167
2168 @node Leaf Functions
2169 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2170
2171 @cindex leaf functions
2172 @cindex functions, leaf
2173 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2174 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2175 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2176 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2177 normally arrive.
2178
2179 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2180 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2181 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2182 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2183 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2184 functions''.
2185
2186 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2187 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2188 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2189 accomplish this.
2190
2191 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2192 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2193 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2194 function treatment.
2195
2196 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2197 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2198 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2199 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2200 in this vector.
2201
2202 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2203 the treatment of leaf functions.
2204 @end defmac
2205
2206 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2207 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2208 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2209
2210 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2211 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2212 will cause the compiler to abort.
2213
2214 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2215 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2216 this.
2217 @end defmac
2218
2219 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2220 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2221 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2222 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2223 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2224 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2225 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2226 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2227 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2228 functions which only use leaf registers.
2229 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2230 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2231 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2232 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2233 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2234
2235 @node Stack Registers
2236 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2237
2238 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2239 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2240 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2241 stack.
2242
2243 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2244 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2245 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2246 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2247 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2248 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2249 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2250
2251 @defmac STACK_REGS
2252 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2253 @end defmac
2254
2255 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2256 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2257 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2258 @end defmac
2259
2260 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2261 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2262 of the stack.
2263 @end defmac
2264
2265 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2266 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2267 the stack.
2268 @end defmac
2269
2270 @node Register Classes
2271 @section Register Classes
2272 @cindex register class definitions
2273 @cindex class definitions, register
2274
2275 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2276 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2277 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2278 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2279
2280 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2281 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2282 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2283
2284 @findex ALL_REGS
2285 @findex NO_REGS
2286 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2287 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2288 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2289 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2290
2291 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2292 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2293 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2294 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2295 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2296 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2297
2298 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2299 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2300
2301 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2302 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2303 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2304 them in operand constraints.
2305
2306 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2307 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2308 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2309 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2310 (@pxref{Costs}).
2311
2312 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2313 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2314 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2315 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2316 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2317 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2318 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2319
2320 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2321 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2322 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2323 in their union.
2324
2325 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2326 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2327 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2328 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2329 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2330
2331 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2332 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2333 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2334 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2335 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2336 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2337 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2338 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2339 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2340
2341 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2342 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2343 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2344 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2345 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2346 tells how many classes there are.
2347
2348 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2349 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2350 in many of the tables described below.
2351 @end deftp
2352
2353 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2354 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2355
2356 @smallexample
2357 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2358 @end smallexample
2359 @end defmac
2360
2361 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2362 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2363 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2364 @end defmac
2365
2366 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2367 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2368 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2369 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2370 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2371
2372 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2373 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2374 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2375 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2376 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2377 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2378 so on.
2379 @end defmac
2380
2381 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2382 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2383 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2384 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2385 register.
2386 @end defmac
2387
2388 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2389 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2390 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2391 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2392 @end defmac
2393
2394 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2395 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2396 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2397 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2398 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2399 @end defmac
2400
2401 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2402 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2403 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2404 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2405 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2406 @end defmac
2407
2408 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2409 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2410 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2411 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2412 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2413 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2414 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2415 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2416 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2417 @end defmac
2418
2419 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2420 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2421 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2422 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2423 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2424 @end defmac
2425
2426 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2427 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2428 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2429 @end defmac
2430
2431 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2432 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2433 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2434 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2435 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2436 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2437 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2438 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2439 @code{address_operand}.
2440 @end defmac
2441
2442 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2443 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2444 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2445 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2446 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2447 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2448 than other base register uses.
2449
2450 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2451 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2452 @end defmac
2453
2454 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2455 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2456 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2457 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2458 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2459 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2460 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2461 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2462 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2463 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2464 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2465 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2466 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2467 @end defmac
2468
2469 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2470 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2471 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2472 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2473 allocated such a hard register.
2474
2475 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2476 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2477 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2478 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2479 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2480 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2481 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2482 only if neither labeling works.
2483 @end defmac
2484
2485 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2486 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2487 @end deftypefn
2488
2489 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2490 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2491 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2492 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2493 another, smaller class.
2494
2495 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2496
2497 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2498 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2499 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2500 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2501 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2502
2503 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2504 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2505 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2506 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2507 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2508 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2509 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2510 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2511 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2512 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2513 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2514
2515 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2516 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2517 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2518 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2519 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2520 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2521 @end deftypefn
2522
2523 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2524 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2525 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2526 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2527 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2528 safe:
2529
2530 @smallexample
2531 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2532 @end smallexample
2533
2534 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2535 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2536 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2537 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2538 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2539
2540 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2541 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2542 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2543 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2544 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2545 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2546 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2547 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2548 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2549 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2550 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2551
2552 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2553 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2554 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2555 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2556 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2557 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2558 @end defmac
2559
2560 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2561 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2562 input reloads.
2563
2564 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2565 argument.
2566
2567 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2568 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2569 @end deftypefn
2570
2571 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2572 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2573 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2574 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2575 ordinarily be used.
2576
2577 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2578 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2579
2580 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2581 smaller class.
2582
2583 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2584 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2585 @end defmac
2586
2587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2588 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2589 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2590 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2591 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2592 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2593 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2594 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2595 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2596 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2597 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2598 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2599 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2600
2601 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2602 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2603 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2604 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2605 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2606 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2607 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2608 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2609 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2610 of the scratch register(s).
2611
2612 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2613
2614 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2615 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2616 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2617 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2618 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2619
2620 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2621 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2622 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2623 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2624 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2625 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2626
2627 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2628 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2629 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2630 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2631 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2632
2633 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2634 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2635 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2636 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2637 single-register-class
2638 @c [later: or memory]
2639 output constraint.
2640
2641 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2642 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2643 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2644 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2645
2646 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2647 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2648 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2649 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2650 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2651 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2652 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2653 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2654
2655
2656 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2657 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2658 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2659 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2660
2661 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2662 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2663 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2664
2665 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2666 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2667 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2668 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2669 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2670 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2671 @end deftypefn
2672
2673 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2674 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2675 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2676 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2677 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2678
2679 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2680 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2681 reload phase that it may
2682 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2683 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2684 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2685 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2686 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2687 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2688
2689 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2690 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2691 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2692 class required. If the
2693 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2694 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2695 macros identically.
2696
2697 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2698 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2699 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2700 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2701 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2702
2703 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2704 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2705 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2706 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2707 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2708 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2709 register.
2710
2711 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2712 register that
2713 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2714 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2715 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2716 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2717 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2718
2719 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2720 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2721 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2722 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2723
2724 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2725 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2726 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2727 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2728 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2729 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2730 general registers.
2731 @end defmac
2732
2733 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2734 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2735 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2736 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2737 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2738 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2739 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2740
2741 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2742 @end defmac
2743
2744 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2745 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2746 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2747 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2748 defined by this macro.
2749
2750 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2751 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2752 @end defmac
2753
2754 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2755 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2756 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2757 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2758 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2759 same as that of @var{mode}.
2760
2761 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2762 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2763 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2764 registers.
2765
2766 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2767 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2768 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2769 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2770 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2771 details.
2772
2773 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2774 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2775 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2776 @end defmac
2777
2778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2779 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2780 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2781 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2782
2783 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2784 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2785 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2786 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2787 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2788
2789 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2790 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2791 pressure.
2792 @end deftypefn
2793
2794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2795 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2796 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2797
2798 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2799 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2800 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2801 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2802 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2803
2804 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2805 in the reload pass.
2806
2807 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2808 in words.
2809 @end deftypefn
2810
2811 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2812 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2813 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2814
2815 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2816 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2817 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2818 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2819
2820 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2821 in the reload pass.
2822 @end defmac
2823
2824 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2825 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2826 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2827
2828 For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2829 floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2830 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2831 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2832 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2833 as below:
2834
2835 @smallexample
2836 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2837 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2838 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2839 @end smallexample
2840
2841 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2842 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2843 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2844 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2845 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2846 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2847 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2848 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2849 value that the middle-end intended.
2850
2851 @end defmac
2852
2853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2854 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2855 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2856
2857 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2858 @end deftypefn
2859
2860 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2861 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2862 @end deftypefn
2863
2864 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2865 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2866 @end deftypefn
2867
2868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2869 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2870 @end deftypefn
2871
2872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2873 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2874 @end deftypefn
2875
2876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2877 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2878 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2879 register allocation.
2880 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2881 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2882 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2883 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2884 @end deftypefn
2885
2886 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2887 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2888 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2889 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2890 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2891 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2892 addressing.
2893 @end deftypefn
2894
2895 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2896 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2897 @end deftypefn
2898
2899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2900 This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2901 @end deftypefn
2902
2903 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2904 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2905 @end deftypefn
2906
2907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2908 A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2909 @end deftypefn
2910
2911 @node Stack and Calling
2912 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2913 @cindex calling conventions
2914
2915 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2916 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2917
2918 @menu
2919 * Frame Layout::
2920 * Exception Handling::
2921 * Stack Checking::
2922 * Frame Registers::
2923 * Elimination::
2924 * Stack Arguments::
2925 * Register Arguments::
2926 * Scalar Return::
2927 * Aggregate Return::
2928 * Caller Saves::
2929 * Function Entry::
2930 * Profiling::
2931 * Tail Calls::
2932 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2933 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2934 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2935 @end menu
2936
2937 @node Frame Layout
2938 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2939 @cindex stack frame layout
2940 @cindex frame layout
2941
2942 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2943 Here is the basic stack layout.
2944
2945 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2946 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2947 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2948 @end defmac
2949
2950 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2951 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2952 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2953 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2954
2955 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2956 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2957 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2958 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2959 space for the next item on the stack.
2960
2961 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2962 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2963 which is often wrong.
2964 @end defmac
2965
2966 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2967 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2968 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2969 @end defmac
2970
2971 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2972 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2973 addresses on the stack.
2974 @end defmac
2975
2976 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2977 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2978
2979 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2980 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2981 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2982 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2983 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2984 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2985 @end defmac
2986
2987 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2988 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2989 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2990
2991 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2992 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2993 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2994 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2995 @end defmac
2996
2997 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2998 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2999 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3000 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3001
3002 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3003 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3004 @end defmac
3005
3006 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3007 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3008 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3009 function.
3010
3011 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3012 the first argument's address.
3013 @end defmac
3014
3015 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3016 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3017 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3018
3019 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3020 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3021 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3022 @end defmac
3023
3024 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3025 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3026 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3027 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3028 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3029 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3030 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3031 @end defmac
3032
3033 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3034 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3035 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3036 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3037 itself.
3038
3039 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3040 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3041 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3042 @end defmac
3043
3044 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3045 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3046 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3047 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3048 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3049 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3050 @end defmac
3051
3052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3053 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3054 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3055 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3056 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3057 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3058 @end deftypefn
3059
3060 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3061 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3062 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3063 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3064 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3065 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3066 @end defmac
3067
3068 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3069 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3070 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3071 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3072 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3073 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3074
3075 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3076 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3077 determine the return address of other frames.
3078 @end defmac
3079
3080 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3081 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3082 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3083 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3084 @end defmac
3085
3086 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3087 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3088 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3089 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3090 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3091 the stack.
3092
3093 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3094 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3095
3096 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3097 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3098 @end defmac
3099
3100 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3101 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3102 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3103 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3104 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3105
3106 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3107 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3108 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3109 over time.
3110 @end defmac
3111
3112 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3113 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3114 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3115 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3116 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3117 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3118 @end defmac
3119
3120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3121 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3122 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3123 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3124 @smallexample
3125 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3126 @end smallexample
3127 and
3128 @smallexample
3129 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3130 @end smallexample
3131 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3132 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3133 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3134 @end deftypefn
3135
3136 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3137 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3138 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3139 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3140 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3141 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3142
3143 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3144 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3145 @end defmac
3146
3147 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3148 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3149 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3150 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3151 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3152 during virtual register instantiation.
3153
3154 The default value for this macro is
3155 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3156 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3157 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3158 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3159 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3160
3161 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3162 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3163 DWARF 2.
3164 @end defmac
3165
3166 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3167 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3168 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3169 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3170 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3171
3172 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3173 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3174 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3175 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3176 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3177 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3178 should be defined.
3179 @end defmac
3180
3181 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3182 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3183 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3184 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3185 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3186 @end defmac
3187
3188 @node Exception Handling
3189 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3190 @cindex exception handling
3191
3192 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3193 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3194 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3195 @var{N} registers are usable.
3196
3197 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3198 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3199 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3200 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3201 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3202
3203 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3204 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3205 @end defmac
3206
3207 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3208 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3209 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3210 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3211 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3212
3213 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3214 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3215
3216 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3217 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3218 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3219 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3220 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3221 that provided by DWARF 2.
3222 @end defmac
3223
3224 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3225 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3226 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3227 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3228
3229 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3230 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3231 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3232 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3233 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3234 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3235 target call frame.
3236
3237 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3238 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3239 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3240
3241 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3242 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3243 @end defmac
3244
3245 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3246 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3247 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3248 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3249 using it to return to the exception handler.
3250 @end defmac
3251
3252 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3253 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3254 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3255 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3256 and so may be read-only.
3257
3258 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3259 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3260 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3261 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3262
3263 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3264 represented directly.
3265 @end defmac
3266
3267 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3268 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3269 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3270 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3271 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3272
3273 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3274 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3275 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3276 to be emitted.
3277 @end defmac
3278
3279 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3280 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3281 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3282 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3283 through signal frames.
3284
3285 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3286 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3287 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3288 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3289 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3290 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3291 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3292 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3293 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3294
3295 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3296 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3297 @end defmac
3298
3299 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3300 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3301 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3302 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3303
3304 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3305 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3306 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3307 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3308 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3309 be updated in @var{fs}.
3310 @end defmac
3311
3312 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3313 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3314 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3315 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3316 @end defmac
3317
3318 @node Stack Checking
3319 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3320
3321 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3322 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3323 three ways:
3324
3325 @enumerate
3326 @item
3327 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3328 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3329 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3330 other special processing.
3331
3332 @item
3333 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3334 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3335 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3336 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3337 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3338 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3339 approach below.
3340
3341 @item
3342 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3343 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3344 @end enumerate
3345
3346 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3347 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3348 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3349 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3350
3351 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3352 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3353 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3354 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3355 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3356 value of this macro is zero.
3357 @end defmac
3358
3359 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3360 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3361 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3362 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3363 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3364 @end defmac
3365
3366 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3367 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3368 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3369 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3370 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3371 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3372 @end defmac
3373
3374 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3375 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3376 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3377 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3378 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3379 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3380 default value of this macro is zero.
3381 @end defmac
3382
3383 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3384 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3385 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3386 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3387 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3388 architectures and operating systems.
3389 @end defmac
3390
3391 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3392 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3393 in the opposite case.
3394
3395 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3396 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3397 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3398 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3399 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3400 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3401 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3402 @end defmac
3403
3404 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3405 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3406 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3407 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3408 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3409 use the default of four words.
3410 @end defmac
3411
3412 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3413 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3414 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3415 @option{-fstack-check}.
3416 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3417 normally not need to override that default.
3418 @end defmac
3419
3420 @need 2000
3421 @node Frame Registers
3422 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3423
3424 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3425 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3426
3427 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3428 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3429 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3430 the hardware determines which register this is.
3431 @end defmac
3432
3433 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3434 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3435 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3436 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3437 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3438 @end defmac
3439
3440 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3441 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3442 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3443 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3444 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3445 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3446 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3447 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3448 used for the frame pointer.
3449
3450 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3451 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3452 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3453 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3454 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3455 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3456 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3457
3458 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3459 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3460 @end defmac
3461
3462 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3463 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3464 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3465 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3466 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3467 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3468 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3469 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3470 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3471 @end defmac
3472
3473 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3474 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3475 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3476 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3477 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3478 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3479 @end defmac
3480
3481 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3482 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3483 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3484 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3485 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3486 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3487 @end defmac
3488
3489 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3490 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3491 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3492 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3493 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3494 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3495 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3496
3497 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3498 address from the stack.
3499 @end defmac
3500
3501 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3502 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3503 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3504 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3505 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3506 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3507 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3508 not be defined.
3509
3510 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3511
3512 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3513 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3514 @end defmac
3515
3516 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3517 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3518 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3519 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3520 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3521 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3522
3523 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3524
3525 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3526 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3527 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3528 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3529 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3530 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3531 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3532 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3533 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3534 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3535 to refer to those items.
3536 @end deftypefn
3537
3538 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3539 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3540 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3541 DWARF2 exception handling.
3542
3543 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3544 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3545 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3546 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3547 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3548 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3549 registers that are not call-saved.
3550
3551 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3552 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3553 @end defmac
3554
3555 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3556
3557 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3558 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3559
3560 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3561 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3562 @end defmac
3563
3564 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3565
3566 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3567 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3568 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3569 column number to use instead.
3570
3571 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3572 @end defmac
3573
3574 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3575
3576 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3577 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3578 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3579 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3580 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3581
3582 @end defmac
3583
3584 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3585
3586 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3587 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3588 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3589 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3590 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3591
3592 @end defmac
3593
3594 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3595
3596 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3597 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3598 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3599 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3600
3601 @end defmac
3602
3603 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3604
3605 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3606 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3607 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3608 defined and 0 otherwise.
3609
3610 @end defmac
3611
3612 @node Elimination
3613 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3614
3615 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3616 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3617
3618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3619 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3620 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3621 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3622
3623 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3624 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3625 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3626 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3627 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3628 pointer.
3629
3630 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3631 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3632 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3633 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3634 them.
3635
3636 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3637 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3638 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3639
3640 Default return value is @code{false}.
3641 @end deftypefn
3642
3643 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3644 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3645 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3646
3647 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3648 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3649
3650 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3651 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3652 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3653 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3654 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3655
3656 In this case, you might specify:
3657 @smallexample
3658 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3659 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3660 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3661 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3665 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3666 @end defmac
3667
3668 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3669 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3670 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3671 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3672 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3673 knows about.
3674
3675 Default return value is @code{true}.
3676 @end deftypefn
3677
3678 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3679 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3680 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3681 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3682 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3683 @end defmac
3684
3685 @node Stack Arguments
3686 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3687 @cindex arguments on stack
3688 @cindex stack arguments
3689
3690 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3691 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3692 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3693
3694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3695 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3696 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3697 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3698 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3699 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3700 @end deftypefn
3701
3702 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3703 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3704 outgoing arguments.
3705 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3706 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3707 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3708 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3709 @end defmac
3710
3711 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3712 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3713 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3714 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3715 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3716 @end defmac
3717
3718 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3719 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3720 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3721
3722 On some machines, the definition
3723
3724 @smallexample
3725 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3726 @end smallexample
3727
3728 @noindent
3729 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3730 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3731 alignment. Then the definition should be
3732
3733 @smallexample
3734 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3735 @end smallexample
3736
3737 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3738 @end defmac
3739
3740 @findex outgoing_args_size
3741 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3742 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3743 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3744 will be computed and placed into
3745 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3746 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3747 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3748
3749 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3750 is not proper.
3751 @end defmac
3752
3753 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3754 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3755 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3756 registers.
3757
3758 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3759 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3760 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3761 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3762 of the function.
3763
3764 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3765 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3766 which.
3767 @end defmac
3768 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3769 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3770
3771 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3772 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3773 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3774 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3775 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3776 @end defmac
3777
3778 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3779 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3780 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3781 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3782 if the function called is a library function.
3783
3784 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3785 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3786 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3787 @end defmac
3788
3789 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3790 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3791 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3792 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3793 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3794
3795 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3796 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3797 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3798 stack in its natural location.
3799 @end defmac
3800
3801 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3802 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3803 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3804 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3805
3806 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3807 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3808 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3809 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3810
3811 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3812 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3813 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3814 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3815 arguments (if known).
3816
3817 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3818 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3819 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3820 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3821 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3822 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3823
3824 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3825 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3826 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3827
3828 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3829 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3830 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3831 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3832 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3833 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3834 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3835 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3836 number of arguments.
3837 @end deftypefn
3838
3839 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3840 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3841 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3842 when compiling a function call.
3843
3844 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3845 have been accumulated.
3846
3847 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3848 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3849 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3850 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3851 appropriate.
3852 @end defmac
3853
3854 @node Register Arguments
3855 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3856 @cindex arguments in registers
3857 @cindex registers arguments
3858
3859 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3860 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3861 the stack.
3862
3863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3864 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3865 register and if so, which register.
3866
3867 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3868 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3869 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3870 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3871 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3872 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3873 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3874 syntax error has previously occurred.
3875
3876 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3877 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3878 on the stack.
3879
3880 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3881 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3882 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3883 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3884 for more information.
3885
3886 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3887 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3888 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3889 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3890 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3891 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3892 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3893 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3894 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3895 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3896 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3897 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3898 argument is also stored on the stack.
3899
3900 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3901 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3902 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3903
3904 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3905 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3906 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3907 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3908 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3909 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3910
3911 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3912 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3913 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3914 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3915 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3916 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3917 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3918 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3919 a register.
3920 @end deftypefn
3921
3922 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3923 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3924 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3925 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3926 documentation.
3927 @end deftypefn
3928
3929 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3930 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3931 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
3932 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3933 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
3934
3935 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3936 which the caller passes the value, and
3937 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3938 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3939 arrive.
3940
3941 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3942 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3943 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3944
3945 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3946 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3947 @end deftypefn
3948
3949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3950 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3951 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3952 @end deftypefn
3953
3954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3955 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3956 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3957 @end deftypefn
3958
3959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3960 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3961 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3962 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3963 pushed on the stack.
3964
3965 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3966 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3967 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3968 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3969 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3970 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3971 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3972
3973 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3974 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3975 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3976 @end deftypefn
3977
3978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3979 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3980 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3981 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3982 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3983
3984 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3985 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3986 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3987 to that type.
3988 @end deftypefn
3989
3990 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3991 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3992 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
3993 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3994 by the caller.
3995
3996 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
3997 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3998 not be generated.
3999
4000 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4001 @end deftypefn
4002
4003 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4004 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4005 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4006 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4007 of bytes of argument so far.
4008
4009 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4010 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4011 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4012 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4013 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4014 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4015 @end defmac
4016
4017 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4018 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4019 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4020 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4021 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4022 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4023 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4024 @end defmac
4025
4026 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4027 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4028 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4029 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4030 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4031 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4032 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4033 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4034 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4035 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4036 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4037 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4038 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4039
4040 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4041 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4042 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4043 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4044 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4045 never both of them at once.
4046 @end defmac
4047
4048 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4049 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4050 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4051 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4052 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4053 0)} is used instead.
4054 @end defmac
4055
4056 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4057 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4058 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4059 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4060
4061 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4062 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4063 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4064 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4065 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4066 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4067 @end defmac
4068
4069 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4070 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4071 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4072 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4073 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4074 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4075
4076 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4077 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4078 used for arguments without any special help.
4079 @end deftypefn
4080
4081 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4082 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4083 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4084 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4085 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4086 top.
4087 @end defmac
4088
4089 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4090 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4091 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4092 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4093 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4094
4095 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4096 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4097 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4098
4099 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4100 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4101 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4102 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4103 @end defmac
4104
4105 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4106 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4107 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4108 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4109 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4110 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4111 @end defmac
4112
4113 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4114 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4115 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4116 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4117 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4118 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4119 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4120 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4121 required.
4122 @end defmac
4123
4124 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4125 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4126 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4127 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4128 @end deftypefn
4129
4130 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4131 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4132 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4133 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4134 value.
4135 @end deftypefn
4136
4137 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4138 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4139 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4140 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4141 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4142 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4143 stack.
4144 @end defmac
4145
4146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4147 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4148 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4149 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4150 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4151 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4152 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4153 point register.
4154
4155 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4156 false.
4157 @end deftypefn
4158
4159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4160 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4161 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4162 @end deftypefn
4163
4164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4165 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4166 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4167 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4168 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4169 variable.
4170 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4171 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4172 internal type.
4173 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4174 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4175 macro to iterate through all types.
4176 @end deftypefn
4177
4178 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4179 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4180 @var{fndecl}.
4181 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4182 @end deftypefn
4183
4184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4185 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4186 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4187 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4188 @end deftypefn
4189
4190 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4191 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4192 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4193 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4194 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4195 @end deftypefn
4196
4197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4198 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4199 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4200 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4201 @end deftypefn
4202
4203 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4204 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4205 @end deftypefn
4206
4207 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4208 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4209 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4210 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4211 must work.
4212
4213 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4214 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4215 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4216 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4217 @end deftypefn
4218
4219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4220 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4221 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4222 must have move patterns for this mode.
4223 @end deftypefn
4224
4225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4226 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4227 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4228 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4229 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4230
4231 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4232 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4233 has operations like:
4234
4235 @smallexample
4236 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4237 @end smallexample
4238
4239 where the return type is defined as:
4240
4241 @smallexample
4242 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4243 @{
4244 int8x8_t val[3];
4245 @} int8x8x3_t;
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4249 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4250 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4251 @end deftypefn
4252
4253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4254 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4255 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4256 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4257 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4258 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4259 @end deftypefn
4260
4261 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4262 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4263 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4264 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type
4265 is not supported, return @code{VOIDmode}. The default version of this
4266 hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4267 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4268 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4269 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4270 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4271 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4272 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4273 @code{VOIDmode}. The hook is only called for values of @var{n} and
4274 @var{extended} that are valid according to ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that
4275 is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or, if @var{extended} is false, 16 or
4276 greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4277 @end deftypefn
4278
4279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4280 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4281 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4282 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4283 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4284 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4285 for any mode.
4286
4287 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4288 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4289 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4290 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4291 insn.
4292
4293 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4294 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4295 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4296 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4297 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4298 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4299 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4300 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4301 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4302
4303 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4304 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4305 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4306 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4307 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4308 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4309 @end deftypefn
4310
4311 @node Scalar Return
4312 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4313 @cindex return values in registers
4314 @cindex values, returned by functions
4315 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4316
4317 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4318 values---values that can fit in registers.
4319
4320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4321
4322 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4323 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4324 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4325 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4326 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4327 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4328 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4329 a function returns a value.
4330
4331 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4332 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4333 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4334 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4335 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4336 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4337 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4338 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4339 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4340 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4341 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4342 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4343
4344 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4345 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4346 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4347
4348 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4349 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4350 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4351 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4352 known.
4353
4354 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4355 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4356 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4357 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4358
4359 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4360 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4361 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4362 @end deftypefn
4363
4364 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4365 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4366 a new target instead.
4367 @end defmac
4368
4369 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4370 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4371 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4372
4373 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4374 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4375 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4376 compiled.
4377 @end defmac
4378
4379 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4380 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4381 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4382
4383 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4384 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4385 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4386
4387 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4388 @end deftypefn
4389
4390 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4391 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4392 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4393
4394 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4395 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4396 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4397 suffices:
4398
4399 @smallexample
4400 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4401 @end smallexample
4402
4403 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4404 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4405 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4406
4407 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4408 for a new target instead.
4409 @end defmac
4410
4411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4412 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4413 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4414
4415 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4416 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4417 recognized by this target hook.
4418
4419 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4420 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4421 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4422
4423 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4424 @end deftypefn
4425
4426 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4427 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4428 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4429 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4430 @end defmac
4431
4432 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4433 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4434 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4435 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4436 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4437 undesirable on your target.
4438 @end deftypevr
4439
4440 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4441 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4442 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4443 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4444 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4445
4446 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4447 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4448 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4449 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4450 @code{SImode} rtx.
4451 @end deftypefn
4452
4453 @node Aggregate Return
4454 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4455 @cindex aggregates as return values
4456 @cindex large return values
4457 @cindex returning aggregate values
4458 @cindex structure value address
4459
4460 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4461 cases), the value is not returned according to
4462 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4463 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4464 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4465 address}.
4466
4467 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4468 memory.
4469
4470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4471 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4472 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4473 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4474 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4475 libcalls.
4476
4477 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4478 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4479 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4480 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4481 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4482 values, and 0 otherwise.
4483
4484 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4485 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4486 to indicate this.
4487 @end deftypefn
4488
4489 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4490 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4491 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4492 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4493 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4494 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4495 target hook.
4496
4497 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4498 @end defmac
4499
4500 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4501 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4502 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4503 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4504 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4505 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4506 argument.
4507
4508 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4509 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4510 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4511 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4512 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4513 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4514 the caller.
4515
4516 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4517 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4518 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4519 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4520 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4521 @end deftypefn
4522
4523 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4524 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4525 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4526 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4527
4528 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4529 pass an address to the subroutine.
4530
4531 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4532 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4533 @end defmac
4534
4535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4536 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4537 @end deftypefn
4538
4539 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4540 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4541 @end deftypefn
4542
4543 @node Caller Saves
4544 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4545
4546 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4547 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4548 must live across calls.
4549
4550 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4551 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4552 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4553 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4554 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4555 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4556 @end defmac
4557
4558 @node Function Entry
4559 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4560 @cindex function entry and exit
4561 @cindex prologue
4562 @cindex epilogue
4563
4564 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4565 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4566
4567 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4568 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4569 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4570 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4571 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4572 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4573 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4574
4575 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4576 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4577
4578 @findex regs_ever_live
4579 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4580 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4581 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4582 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4583 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4584 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4585
4586 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4587 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4588 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4589 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4590 registers are used in the function.
4591
4592 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4593 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4594 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4595 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4596 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4597 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4598 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4599
4600 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4601 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4602 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4603 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4604 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4605 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4606 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4607 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4608 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4609 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4610 @end deftypefn
4611
4612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4613 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4614 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4615 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4616 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4617 @end deftypefn
4618
4619 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4620 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4621 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4622 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4623 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4624 @end deftypefn
4625
4626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4627 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4628 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4629 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4630 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4631 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4632 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4633 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4634
4635 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4636 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4637 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4638 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4639
4640 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4641 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4642 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4643 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4644 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4645 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4646
4647 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4648 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4649 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4650 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4651 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4652 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4653
4654 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4655 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4656 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4657 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4658
4659 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4660 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4661 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4662 number of arguments.
4663
4664 @findex pops_args
4665 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4666 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4667 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4668 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4669 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4670 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4671 @end deftypefn
4672
4673 @itemize @bullet
4674 @item
4675 @findex pretend_args_size
4676 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4677 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4678 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4679 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4680 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4681 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4682 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4683 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4684 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4685 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4686
4687 @item
4688 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4689 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4690 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4691 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4692 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4693 a save area.
4694
4695 @item
4696 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4697 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4698 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4699 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4700
4701 @item
4702 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4703 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4704 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4705 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4706 @end itemize
4707
4708 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4709 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4710 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4711 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4712 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4713 default is 0.
4714
4715 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4716 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4717 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4718 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4719 @end defmac
4720
4721 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4722 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4723 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4724 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4725 @end defmac
4726
4727 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4728 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4729 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4730 on entry to an exception edge.
4731 @end defmac
4732
4733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4734 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4735 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4736 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4737 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4738 the real function.
4739
4740 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4741 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4742 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4743 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4744 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4745 all other incoming arguments.
4746
4747 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4748 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4749 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4750
4751 @smallexample
4752 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4753 @end smallexample
4754
4755 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4756 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4757 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4758 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4759
4760 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4761 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4762 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4763 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4764
4765 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4766 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4767 some targets, but probably not.
4768
4769 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4770 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4771 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4772 not support varargs.
4773 @end deftypefn
4774
4775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4776 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4777 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4778 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4779 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4780 previously exposed.
4781 @end deftypefn
4782
4783 @node Profiling
4784 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4785 @cindex profiling, code generation
4786
4787 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4788
4789 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4790 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4791 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4792
4793 @findex mcount
4794 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4795 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4796 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4797 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4798
4799 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4800 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4801 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4802 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4803 @end defmac
4804
4805 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4806 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4807 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4808 not support profiling.
4809 @end defmac
4810
4811 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4812 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4813 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4814 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4815 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4816 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4817 @end defmac
4818
4819 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4820 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4821 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4822 @end defmac
4823
4824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4825 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4826 @end deftypefn
4827
4828 @node Tail Calls
4829 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4830 @cindex tail calls
4831
4832 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4833 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4834 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4835 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4836
4837 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4838 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4839 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4840 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4841 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4842 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4843 @end deftypefn
4844
4845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4846 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4847 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4848 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4849 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4850 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4851 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4852 @end deftypefn
4853
4854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4855 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4856 @end deftypefn
4857
4858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4859 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4860 @end deftypefn
4861
4862 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
4863 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
4864 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
4865
4866 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
4867 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
4868 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
4869 up the static chain, etc.
4870
4871 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
4872 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
4873 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
4874 independent parts of GCC.
4875
4876 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
4877 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
4878 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
4879 paths where this would unnecessary.
4880
4881 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
4882 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
4883 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
4884 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
4885 generic code.
4886
4887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
4888 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4889 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
4890 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
4891 shrink-wrapping.
4892 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
4893 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
4894 @end deftypefn
4895
4896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
4897 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4898 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
4899 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
4900 @end deftypefn
4901
4902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
4903 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
4904 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
4905 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
4906 epilogue instead.
4907 @end deftypefn
4908
4909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4910 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4911 @end deftypefn
4912
4913 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4914 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4915 @end deftypefn
4916
4917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4918 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
4919 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
4920 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
4921 will be deleted after this call.
4922 @end deftypefn
4923
4924 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4925 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4926 @cindex stack smashing protection
4927
4928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4929 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4930 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4931 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4932 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4933 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4934
4935 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4936 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4937 @end deftypefn
4938
4939 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4940 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4941 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4942 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4943
4944 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4945 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4946 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4947 @end deftypefn
4948
4949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
4950 Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
4951 @end deftypefn
4952
4953 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4954 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4955 @end deftypefn
4956
4957 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4958 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4959 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4960
4961 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4962 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4963 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4964 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4965 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4966 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4967 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4968 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4969 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4970 @end deftypevr
4971
4972 @node Varargs
4973 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4974 @cindex varargs implementation
4975
4976 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4977 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4978 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4979 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4980 conditionals to include it.
4981
4982 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4983 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4984 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4985 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4986 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4987 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4988
4989 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4990 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4991 below.
4992
4993 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4994 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4995 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4996 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4997 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4998
4999 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5000 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5001 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5002 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5003
5004 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5005 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5006 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5007 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5008 to use them for its own purposes.
5009 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5010 @c 10feb93
5011 @end defmac
5012
5013 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5014 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5015 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5016 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5017 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5018 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5019 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5020 of the current function.
5021 @end defmac
5022
5023 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5024 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5025 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5026 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5027 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5028 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5029
5030 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5031 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5032 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5033
5034 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5035 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5036 @end defmac
5037
5038 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5039
5040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5041 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5042 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5043 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5044 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5045 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5046 @end deftypefn
5047
5048 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5049 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5050 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5051 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5052 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5053 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5054 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5055 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5056
5057 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5058 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5059 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5060 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5061
5062 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5063 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5064 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5065 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5066 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5067 frame.
5068
5069 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5070 compile time without knowing their data types,
5071 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5072 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5073 for all data types.
5074
5075 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5076 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5077 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5078 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5079 not generate any instructions in this case.
5080 @end deftypefn
5081
5082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5083 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5084 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5085
5086 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5087 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5088 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5089 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5090 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5091 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5092 except the last are treated as named.
5093
5094 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5095 @end deftypefn
5096
5097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5098 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5099 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5100 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5101 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5102 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5103 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5104 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5105 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5106 registers if a target needs it.
5107 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5108 passed instead of an argument register.
5109 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5110 @end deftypefn
5111
5112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5113 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5114 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5115 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5116 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5117 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5118 @end deftypefn
5119
5120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5121 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5122 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5123 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5124 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5125 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5126 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5127 @end deftypefn
5128
5129 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5130 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5131 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5132 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5133 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5134 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5135 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5136 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5137 @end deftypefn
5138
5139 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5140 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5141 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5142 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5143 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5144 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5145 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5146 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5147 @end deftypefn
5148
5149 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5150 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5151 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5152 loaded bounds.
5153 @end deftypefn
5154
5155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5156 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5157 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5158 @end deftypefn
5159
5160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5161 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5162 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5163 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5164 @end deftypefn
5165
5166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5167 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5168 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5169 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5170 @end deftypefn
5171
5172 @node Trampolines
5173 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5174 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5175 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5176
5177 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5178 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5179 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5180 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5181 trampoline.
5182
5183 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5184 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5185 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5186 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5187 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5188 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5189 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5190 operands.
5191
5192 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5193 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5194 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5195 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5196 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5197 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5198 separately.
5199
5200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5201 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5202 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5203 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5204 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5205
5206 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5207 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5208 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5209 to generate it on the spot.
5210 @end deftypefn
5211
5212 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5213 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5214 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5215 @end defmac
5216
5217 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5218 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5219 @end defmac
5220
5221 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5222 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5223
5224 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5225 is used for aligning trampolines.
5226 @end defmac
5227
5228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5229 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5230 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5231 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5232 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5233 when it is called.
5234
5235 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5236 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5237 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5238 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5239 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5240 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5241
5242 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5243 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5244 initializing the trampoline proper.
5245 @end deftypefn
5246
5247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5248 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5249 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5250 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5251 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5252 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5253 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5254 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5255 @end deftypefn
5256
5257 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5258 This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit
5259 from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the
5260 standard trampolines. Such descriptors are created at run time on the
5261 stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated
5262 code must be prepared to deal with them. This hook should be defined to 0
5263 if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,
5264 like for example HP-PA or IA-64. Using descriptors for nested functions
5265 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5266 it to be made executable.
5267
5268 The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification
5269 scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it
5270 gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared
5271 with function addresses. The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is
5272 already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.
5273 @end deftypevr
5274
5275 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5276 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5277 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5278 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5279
5280 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5281 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5282 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5283 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5284 latter makes initialization faster.
5285
5286 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5287 the following macro.
5288
5289 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5290 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5291 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5292 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5293 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5294 @end defmac
5295
5296 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5297 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5298 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5299 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5300 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5301
5302 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5303 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5304 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5305 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5306 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5307
5308 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5309 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5310 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5311 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5312 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5313 special assembler code.
5314 @end defmac
5315
5316 @node Library Calls
5317 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5318 @cindex library subroutine names
5319 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5320
5321 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5322 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5323
5324 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5325 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5326 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5327 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5328 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5329 @end defmac
5330
5331 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5332 @findex init_one_libfunc
5333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5334 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5335 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5336 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5337 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5338 library routines.
5339
5340 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5341 @end deftypefn
5342
5343 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5344 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5345 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5346 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5347 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5348 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5349 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5350 @end deftypevr
5351
5352 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5353 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5354 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5355 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5356 return a tristate.
5357
5358 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5359 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5360 don't need to define this macro.
5361 @end defmac
5362
5363 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5364 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5365 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5366 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5367 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5368 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5369 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5370 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5371 @end defmac
5372
5373 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5374 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5375 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5376 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5377 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5378 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5379 @end defmac
5380
5381 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5382 @findex matherr
5383 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5384 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5385 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5386 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5387 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5388 system.
5389
5390 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5391 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5392 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5393 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5394 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5395 @end defmac
5396
5397 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5398 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5399 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5400 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5401 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5402 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5403 @end defmac
5404
5405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5406 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5407 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5408 @end deftypefn
5409
5410 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5411 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5412 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5413 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5414 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5415 the NeXT runtime installed.
5416
5417 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5418 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5419 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5420
5421 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5422 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5423 @end defmac
5424
5425 @node Addressing Modes
5426 @section Addressing Modes
5427 @cindex addressing modes
5428
5429 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5430 This is about addressing modes.
5431
5432 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5433 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5434 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5435 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5436 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5437 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5438 @end defmac
5439
5440 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5441 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5442 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5443 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5444 the size of the memory operand.
5445 @end defmac
5446
5447 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5448 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5449 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5450 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5451 @end defmac
5452
5453 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5454 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5455 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5456 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5457 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5458 constant addresses are supported.
5459 @end defmac
5460
5461 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5462 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5463 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5464 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5465 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5466 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5467 @end defmac
5468
5469 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5470 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5471 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5472 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5473 accept.
5474 @end defmac
5475
5476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5477 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5478 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5479
5480 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5481 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5482 desired by the caller.
5483
5484 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5485 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5486 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5487 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5488 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5489 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5490 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5491 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5492
5493 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5494 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5495 register is required.
5496
5497 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5498 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5499 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5500 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5501 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5502
5503 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5504 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5505 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5506 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5507 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5508
5509 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5510 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5511 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5512 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5513 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5514 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5515 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5516 Format}.
5517
5518 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5519 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5520 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5521 has this syntax:
5522
5523 @example
5524 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5525 @end example
5526
5527 @noindent
5528 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5529 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5530
5531 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5532 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5533 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5534 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5535 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5536
5537 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5538 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5539 @end deftypefn
5540
5541 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5542 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5543 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5544 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5545 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5546 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5547 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5548 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5549 @code{'m'} constraint.
5550 @end defmac
5551
5552 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5553 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5554 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5555 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5556 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5557
5558 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5559 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5560
5561 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5562 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5563 @end defmac
5564
5565 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5566 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5567 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5568 address.
5569
5570 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5571 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5572 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5573 @var{x}.
5574
5575 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5576 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5577 should return the new @var{x}.
5578
5579 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5580 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5581 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5582 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5583 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5584 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5585 strategy can generate better code.
5586 @end deftypefn
5587
5588 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5589 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5590 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5591 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5592 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5593 performance reasons.
5594
5595 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5596 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5597 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5598 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5599 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5600 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5601 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5602 be shared.
5603
5604 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5605 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5606 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5607 of reload internals.
5608
5609 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5610 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5611 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5612
5613 @findex push_reload
5614 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5615 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5616 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5617
5618 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5619 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5620 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5621 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5622 @code{push_reload}.
5623
5624 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5625 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5626 the address has become legitimate.
5627
5628 @findex copy_rtx
5629 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5630 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5631 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5632 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5633 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5634 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5635 @end defmac
5636
5637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5638 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5639 space @var{addrspace} can have
5640 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5641 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5642 but not others.
5643
5644 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5645 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5646 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5647 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5648
5649 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5650
5651 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5652 @end deftypefn
5653
5654 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5655 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5656 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5657 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5658
5659 The default definition returns true.
5660 @end deftypefn
5661
5662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5663 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5664 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5665 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5666 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5667 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5668 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5669 into their original form.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5673 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5674 debug sections.
5675 @end deftypefn
5676
5677 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5678 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5679 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5680 of @var{x}.
5681
5682 The default version of this hook returns false.
5683
5684 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5685 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5686 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5687 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5688 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5689 @end deftypefn
5690
5691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5692 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5693 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5694 of @var{x}.
5695
5696 The default version returns false for all constants.
5697 @end deftypefn
5698
5699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5700 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5701 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5702
5703 The default version returns true for all decls.
5704 @end deftypefn
5705
5706 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5707 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5708 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5709 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5710 @end deftypefn
5711
5712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5713 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5714 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5715 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5716 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5717
5718 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5719 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5720 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5721 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5722 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5723 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5724 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5725 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5726 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5727 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5728 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5729
5730 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5731 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5732 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5733 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5734 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5735 described above.
5736 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5737 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5738 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5739 @end deftypefn
5740
5741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5742 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5743 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5744 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5745 @end deftypefn
5746
5747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5748 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5749 @end deftypefn
5750
5751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5752 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5753 @end deftypefn
5754
5755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5756 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5757 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5758 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5759 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5760 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5761
5762 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5763 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5764 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5765 @end deftypefn
5766
5767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5768 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5769 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5770 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5771 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5772 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5773 @end deftypefn
5774
5775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5776 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5777 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5778 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5779 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5780 @end deftypefn
5781
5782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5783 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5784 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5785 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5786 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5787 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5788 @end deftypefn
5789
5790 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5791 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5792 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5793 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5794 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5795 @end deftypefn
5796
5797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5798 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5799 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5800 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5801 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5802 @end deftypefn
5803
5804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5805 This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5806 of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5807 vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5808 @end deftypefn
5809
5810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5811 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5812 @end deftypefn
5813
5814 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5815 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5816 @end deftypefn
5817
5818 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5819 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5820 @end deftypefn
5821
5822 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5823 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5824 @end deftypefn
5825
5826 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5827 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5828 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5829 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5830 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5831 loads.
5832 @end deftypefn
5833
5834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5835 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5836 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5837 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5838 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5839 stores.
5840 @end deftypefn
5841
5842 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5843 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5844 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5845 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5846 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5847 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5848 @end deftypefn
5849
5850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5851 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5852 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5853 @end deftypefn
5854
5855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5856 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5857 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5858 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5859 to use it.
5860 @end deftypefn
5861
5862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
5863 Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
5864 @end deftypefn
5865
5866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
5867 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5868 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5869 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5870 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5871 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
5872 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
5873 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
5874 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5875 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5876 provide dimensions larger than 1.
5877 @end deftypefn
5878
5879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5880 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5881 or zero if unbounded.
5882 @end deftypefn
5883
5884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
5885 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5886 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5887 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5888 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5889 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5890 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5891 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
5892 @end deftypefn
5893
5894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5895 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5896 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5897 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5898 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5899 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5900 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5901 @end deftypefn
5902
5903 @node Anchored Addresses
5904 @section Anchored Addresses
5905 @cindex anchored addresses
5906 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5907
5908 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5909 For example, if we have:
5910
5911 @smallexample
5912 static int a, b, c;
5913 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5914 @end smallexample
5915
5916 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5917 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5918 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5919 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5920 be something like:
5921
5922 @smallexample
5923 int foo (void)
5924 @{
5925 register int *xr = &x;
5926 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5927 @}
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5931 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5932
5933 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5934 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5935 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5936 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5937
5938 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5939 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5940 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5941 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5942 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5943 @end deftypevr
5944
5945 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5946 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5947 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5948 value is 0.
5949 @end deftypevr
5950
5951 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5952 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5953 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5954 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5955 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5956
5957 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5958 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5959 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5960 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5961 @end deftypefn
5962
5963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5964 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5965 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5966 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5967
5968 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5969 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5970 or target-specific sections.
5971 @end deftypefn
5972
5973 @node Condition Code
5974 @section Condition Code Status
5975 @cindex condition code status
5976
5977 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5978 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5979
5980 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5981 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5982 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5983 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5984 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5985 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5986 most RISC machines.
5987
5988 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5989 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5990 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5991 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5992 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5993 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5994
5995 These restrictions can prevent important
5996 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5997 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5998 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5999 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6000 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6001
6002 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6003 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6004 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6005 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6006 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6007 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6008 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6009
6010 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6011 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6012 interested in most macros in this section.
6013
6014 @menu
6015 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6016 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6017 @end menu
6018
6019 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6020 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6021 @findex cc0
6022
6023 @findex cc_status
6024 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6025 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6026 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6027 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6028 currently based, and several standard flags.
6029
6030 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6031 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6032 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6033
6034 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6035 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6036 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6037
6038 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6039 @end defmac
6040
6041 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6042 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6043 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6044 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6045 define this macro to initialize it.
6046
6047 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6048 @end defmac
6049
6050 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6051 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6052 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6053 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6054 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6055 set @code{(cc0)}.
6056
6057 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6058
6059 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6060 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6061 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6062 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6063 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6064 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6065 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6066 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6067 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6068 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6069 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6070 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6071 condition code value.
6072
6073 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6074 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6075 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6076 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6077 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6078 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6079 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6080
6081 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6082 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6083 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6084 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6085 @end defmac
6086
6087 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6088 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6089 @findex CCmode
6090 @findex MODE_CC
6091
6092 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6093 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6094 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6095 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6096 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6097 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6098 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6099 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6100 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6101 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6102 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6103
6104 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6105 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6106 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6107 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6108 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6109 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6110 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6111
6112 @smallexample
6113 (define_insn ""
6114 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6115 (compare:CCNZ
6116 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6117 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6118 (const_int 0)))]
6119 ""
6120 "@dots{}")
6121 @end smallexample
6122
6123 @noindent
6124 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6125 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6126
6127 @smallexample
6128 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6129 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6130 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6131 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6132 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6133 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6134 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6138 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6139 this section.
6140
6141 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6142 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6143 @end defmac
6144
6145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6146 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6147 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6148 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6149 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6150
6151 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6152 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6153 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6154 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6155 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6156 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6157 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6158
6159 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6160 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6161 @file{md} file.
6162
6163 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6164 comparison code or operands.
6165 @end deftypefn
6166
6167 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6168 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6169 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6170 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6171 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6172
6173 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6174 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6175 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6176 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6177
6178 @smallexample
6179 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6180 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6181 @end smallexample
6182 @end defmac
6183
6184 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6185 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6186 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6187 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6188 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6189 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6190 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6191 like:
6192
6193 @smallexample
6194 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6195 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6196 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6197 @end smallexample
6198 @end defmac
6199
6200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6201 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6202 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6203 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6204 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6205 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6206 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6207 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6208 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6209 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6210 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6211
6212 The default version of this hook returns false.
6213 @end deftypefn
6214
6215 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6216 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6217 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6218 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6219 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6220 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6221 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6222
6223 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6224 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6225 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6226 @end deftypefn
6227
6228 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6229 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6230 @end deftypevr
6231
6232 @node Costs
6233 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6234 @cindex costs of instructions
6235 @cindex relative costs
6236 @cindex speed of instructions
6237
6238 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6239 on the target machine.
6240
6241 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6242 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6243 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6244 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6245 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6246 that.
6247
6248 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6249 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6250 registers if they are not general registers.
6251
6252 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6253 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6254 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6255 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6256 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6257 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6258
6259 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6260 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6261 @end defmac
6262
6263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6264 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6265 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6266 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6267 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6268 that.
6269
6270 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6271 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6272 registers if they are not general registers.
6273
6274 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6275 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6276 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6277 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6278 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6279 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6280
6281 The default version of this function returns 2.
6282 @end deftypefn
6283
6284 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6285 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6286 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6287 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6288 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6289 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6290 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6291
6292 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6293 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6294 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6295 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6296 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6297 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6298
6299 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6300 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6301 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6302 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6303 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6304 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6305 are the same as to this macro.
6306
6307 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6308 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6309 @end defmac
6310
6311 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6312 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6313 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6314 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6315 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6316 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6317 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6318
6319 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6320 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6321 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6322 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6323 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6324 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6325
6326 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6327 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6328 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6329 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6330 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6331 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6332 are the same as to this target hook.
6333 @end deftypefn
6334
6335 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6336 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6337 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6338 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6339 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6340 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6341 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6342 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6343 @end defmac
6344
6345 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6346 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6347 ordinarily expect.
6348
6349 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6350 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6351 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6352 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6353 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6354 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6355
6356 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6357 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6358 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6359 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6360 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6361 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6362 @end defmac
6363
6364 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6365 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6366 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6367 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6368 handler. This macro is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e. when
6369 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6370
6371 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6372 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6373 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6374 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6375 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6376
6377 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6378 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6379 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6380 @end defmac
6381
6382 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6383 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6384 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6385 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6386 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6387
6388 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6389 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6390 the number of such sequences.
6391
6392 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6393 optimized for speed rather than size.
6394
6395 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6396 @end defmac
6397
6398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6399 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6400 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6401 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6402 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6403 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6404 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6405 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6406
6407 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6408 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6409 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6410 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6411 units.
6412
6413 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6414 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6415 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6416 under consideration.
6417
6418 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6419 optimized for speed rather than size.
6420
6421 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6422 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6423 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6424 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6425 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6426 the body of the memory operation.
6427
6428 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6429 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6430 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6431 @end deftypefn
6432
6433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6434 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6435 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6436 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6437 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6438 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6439 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6440 negative number from this hook.
6441 @end deftypefn
6442
6443 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6444 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6445 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6446 @end defmac
6447
6448 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6449 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6450 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6451 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6452 @end defmac
6453
6454 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6455 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6456 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6457 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6458 @end defmac
6459
6460 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6461 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6462 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6463 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6464 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6465
6466 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6467 optimized for speed rather than size.
6468
6469 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6470 @end defmac
6471
6472 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6473 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6474 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6475 a block set insn or a library call.
6476 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6477 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6478
6479 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6480 optimized for speed rather than size.
6481
6482 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6483 @end defmac
6484
6485 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6486 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6487 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6488 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6489 @end defmac
6490
6491 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6492 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6493 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6494 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6495 @end defmac
6496
6497 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6498 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6499 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6500 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6501 @end defmac
6502
6503 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6504 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6505 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6506 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6507 @end defmac
6508
6509 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6510 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6511 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6512 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6513 @end defmac
6514
6515 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6516 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6517 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6518 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6519 @end defmac
6520
6521 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6522 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6523 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6524 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6525 @end defmac
6526
6527 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6528 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6529 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6530 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6531 @end defmac
6532
6533 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6534 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6535 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6536 @end defmac
6537
6538 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6539 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6540 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6541 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6542 @end defmac
6543
6544 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6545 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6546 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6547 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6548 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6549 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6550
6551 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6552 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6553 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6554
6555 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6556 @end deftypefn
6557
6558 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6559 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6560
6561 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6562 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6563 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6564 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6565 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6566 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6567 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6568
6569 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6570 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6571
6572 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6573 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6574 instructions.
6575
6576 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6577 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6578 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6579 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6580 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6581
6582 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6583 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6584 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6585
6586 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6587 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6588 @end deftypefn
6589
6590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6591 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6592 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6593 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6594
6595 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6596 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6597 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6598 all addresses will have equal costs.
6599
6600 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6601 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6602 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6603
6604 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6605 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6606 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6607 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6608 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6609 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6610 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6611 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6612
6613 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6614
6615 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6616 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6617 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6618 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6619 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6620 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6621 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6622 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6623 @end deftypefn
6624
6625 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6626 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6627 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6628 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6629 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6630 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6631 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6632 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6633 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6634 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6635
6636 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6637 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6638 were true.
6639
6640 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6641 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6642 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6643 @end deftypefn
6644
6645 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6646 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6647 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6648 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6649 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6650 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6651 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6652 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6653 @end deftypefn
6654
6655 @node Scheduling
6656 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6657
6658 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6659 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6660 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6661 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6662
6663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6664 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6665 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6666 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6667 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6668 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6669 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6670 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6671 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6672 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6673 @end deftypefn
6674
6675 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6676 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6677 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6678 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6679 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6680 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6681 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6682 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6683 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6684 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6685 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6686 was scheduled.
6687 @end deftypefn
6688
6689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
6690 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6691 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6692 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
6693 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
6694 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6695 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6696 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6697 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6698 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6699 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6700 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6701 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6705 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6706 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6707 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6708 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6709 scheduling priorities of insns.
6710 @end deftypefn
6711
6712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6713 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6714 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6715 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6716 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6717 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6718 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6719 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6720 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6721 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6722 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6723 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6724 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6725 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6726 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6727 @end deftypefn
6728
6729 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6730 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6731 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6732 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6733 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6734 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6735 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6736 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6737 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6738 @end deftypefn
6739
6740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6741 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6742 @end deftypefn
6743
6744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6745 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6746 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6747 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6748 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6749 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6750 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6751 @end deftypefn
6752
6753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6754 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6755 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6756 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6757 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6758 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6759 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6760 calculated.
6761 @end deftypefn
6762
6763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6764 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6765 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6766 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6767 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6768 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6769 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6770 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6771 @end deftypefn
6772
6773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6774 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6775 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6776 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6777 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6778 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6779 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6780 @end deftypefn
6781
6782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6783 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6784 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6785 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6786 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6787 @end deftypefn
6788
6789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6790 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6791 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6792 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6793 @end deftypefn
6794
6795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6796 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6797 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6798 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6799 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6800 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6801 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6802 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6803 @end deftypefn
6804
6805 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6806 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6807 @end deftypefn
6808
6809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6810 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6811 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6812 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6813 @end deftypefn
6814
6815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6816 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6817 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6818 @end deftypefn
6819
6820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6821 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6822 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6823 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6824 state on a single insn is not enough.
6825 @end deftypefn
6826
6827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6828 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6829 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6830 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6831 state on a single insn is not enough.
6832 @end deftypefn
6833
6834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6835 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6836 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6837 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6838 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6839 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6840 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6841 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6842 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6843 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6844 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6845
6846 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6847 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6848 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6849 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6850 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6851 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6852 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6853 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6854 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6855
6856 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6857 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6858 schedules to choose the best one.
6859
6860 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6861 @end deftypefn
6862
6863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6864
6865 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6866 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6867 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6868 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6869 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6870 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6871 number of cycles.
6872 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6873 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6874 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6875
6876 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6877 @end deftypefn
6878
6879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6880 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6881 scheduling.
6882 @end deftypefn
6883
6884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6885 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6886 @end deftypefn
6887
6888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6889 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6890 an instruction.
6891 @end deftypefn
6892
6893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6894 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6895 round of multipass scheduling.
6896 @end deftypefn
6897
6898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6899 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6900 @end deftypefn
6901
6902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6903 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6904 @end deftypefn
6905
6906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6907 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6908 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6909 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6910 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6911 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6912 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6913 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6914 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6915 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6916 and the current processor cycle.
6917 @end deftypefn
6918
6919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6920 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6921 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6922 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6923 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6924 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6925 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6926 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6927 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6928 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6929 and @code{false} otherwise.
6930
6931 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6932 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6933 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6934 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6935 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6936 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6937 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6938 @end deftypefn
6939
6940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6941 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6942 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6943 per instruction data structures.
6944 @end deftypefn
6945
6946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6947 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6948 @end deftypefn
6949
6950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6951 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6952 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6953 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6954 @end deftypefn
6955
6956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6957 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6958 @end deftypefn
6959
6960 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6961 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6962 @end deftypefn
6963
6964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6965 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6966 @end deftypefn
6967
6968 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6969 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6970 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6971 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6972 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6973 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6974 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6975 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6976 the generated speculative pattern.
6977 @end deftypefn
6978
6979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6980 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6981 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6982 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6983 @end deftypefn
6984
6985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6986 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6987 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6988 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6989 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6990 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6991 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6992 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6993 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6994 @end deftypefn
6995
6996 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6997 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6998 enabled/used.
6999 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7000 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7001 @end deftypefn
7002
7003 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7004 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7005 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7006 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7007 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7008 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7009 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7010 @end deftypefn
7011
7012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7013 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7014 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7015 @end deftypefn
7016
7017 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7018 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7019 in its second parameter.
7020 @end deftypefn
7021
7022 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7023 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7024 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7025 also the latencies of operations.
7026 @end deftypevr
7027
7028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7029 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7030 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7031 @end deftypefn
7032
7033 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7034 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7035 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7036 are returned via pointer parameters.
7037
7038 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7039 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7040 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7041 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7042 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7043 should be calculated and returned.
7044
7045 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7046 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7047 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7048 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7049 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7050 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7051 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7052 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7053 instructions.
7054
7055 Given below example:
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7059 add r4, r4, r10
7060 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7061 sub r5, r5, r15
7062 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7063 add r4, r4, r11
7064 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7065 sub r5, r5, r16
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7069 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7070 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7071 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7072 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7073
7074 @smallexample
7075 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7076 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7077 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7078 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7079 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7080 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7081 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7082 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7083 @end smallexample
7084
7085 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7086 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7087 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7088
7089 @smallexample
7090 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7091 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7092 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7093 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7094 add r4, r4, r10
7095 sub r5, r5, r15
7096 add r4, r4, r11
7097 sub r5, r5, r16
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7101
7102 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7103 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7104
7105 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7106 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7107 @end deftypefn
7108
7109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7110 Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7111 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7112 @end deftypefn
7113
7114 @node Sections
7115 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7116 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7117 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7118
7119 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7120 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7121 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7122 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7123 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7124 of sections.
7125
7126 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7127 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7128 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7129 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7130 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7131 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7132 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7133
7134 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7135 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7136 to be string literals.
7137
7138 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7139 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7140 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7141 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7142
7143 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7144 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7145 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7146 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7147 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7148 reuse @code{text_section}.
7149
7150 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7151 if the target does not provide them.
7152
7153 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7154 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7155 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7156 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7157 @end defmac
7158
7159 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7160 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7161 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7162 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7163 @end defmac
7164
7165 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7166 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7167 executed functions in the program.
7168 @end defmac
7169
7170 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7171 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7172 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7173 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7174 @end defmac
7175
7176 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7177 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7178 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7179 initialized, writable small data.
7180 @end defmac
7181
7182 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7183 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7184 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7185 data.
7186 @end defmac
7187
7188 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7189 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7190 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7191 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7192 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7193 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7194 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7195 used.
7196 @end defmac
7197
7198 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7199 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7200 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7201 uninitialized, writable small data.
7202 @end defmac
7203
7204 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7205 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7206 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7207 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7208 @end defmac
7209
7210 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7211 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7212 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7213 default is @code{'T'}.
7214 @end defmac
7215
7216 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7217 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7218 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7219 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7220 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7221 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7222 @end defmac
7223
7224 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7225 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7226 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7227 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7228 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7229 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7230 @end defmac
7231
7232 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7233 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7234 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7235 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7236 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7237 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7238 @end defmac
7239
7240 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7241 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7242 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7243 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7244 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7245 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7246 @end defmac
7247
7248 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7249 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7250 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7251 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7252 @end defmac
7253
7254 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7255 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7256 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7257 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7258 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7259 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7260 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7261 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7262 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7263 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7264 @end defmac
7265
7266 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7267 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7268 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7269 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7270 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7271 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7272 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7273 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7274 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7275 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7276 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7277 @end defmac
7278
7279 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7280 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7281 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7282 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7283 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7284 @end defmac
7285
7286 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7287 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7288 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7289 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7290 readonly data section is used.
7291
7292 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7293 @end defmac
7294
7295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7296 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7297 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7298 of its own that you need to create.
7299
7300 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7301 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7302 described below.
7303 @end deftypefn
7304
7305 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7306 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7307 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7308 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7309 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7310
7311 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7312 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7313 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7314 in read-only sections even in executables.
7315 @end deftypefn
7316
7317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7318 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7319 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7320 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7321 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7322 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7323 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7324
7325 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7326 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7327
7328 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7329 @end deftypefn
7330
7331 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7332 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7333 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7334
7335 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7336 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7337 it is unlikely to be called.
7338 @end defmac
7339
7340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7341 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7342 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7343 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7344 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7345
7346 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7347 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7348 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7349 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7350 @end deftypefn
7351
7352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7353 Return the readonly data section associated with
7354 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7355 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7356 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7357 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7358 otherwise.
7359 @end deftypefn
7360
7361 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7362 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7363 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7364 the string if a different section name should be used.
7365 @end deftypevr
7366
7367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7368 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7369 @end deftypefn
7370
7371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7372 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7373 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7374 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7375 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7376 in bits.
7377
7378 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7379 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7380 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7381 @end deftypefn
7382
7383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7384 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7385 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7386 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7387 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7388 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7389 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7390 returns the @var{id} provided.
7391 @end deftypefn
7392
7393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7394 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7395 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7396 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7397
7398 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7399 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7400 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7401 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7402 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7403
7404 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7405 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7406 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7407 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7408 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7409 leave it alone.)
7410
7411 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7412 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7413 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7414 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7415 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7416 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7417
7418 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7419 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7420 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7421 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7422 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7423 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7424
7425 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7426 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7427 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7428 before overriding it.
7429 @end deftypefn
7430
7431 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7432 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7433 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7434 may have added.
7435 @end deftypefn
7436
7437 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7438 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7439 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7440 @end deftypefn
7441
7442 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7443 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7444 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7445 @end deftypevr
7446
7447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7448 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7449
7450 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7451 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7452 @end deftypefn
7453
7454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7455 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7456 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7457 or executable image).
7458
7459 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7460 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7461 currently supported object file formats.
7462 @end deftypefn
7463
7464 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7465 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7466 The default value is false.
7467 @end deftypevr
7468
7469
7470 @node PIC
7471 @section Position Independent Code
7472 @cindex position independent code
7473 @cindex PIC
7474
7475 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7476 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7477 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7478 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7479 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7480 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7481 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7482 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7483 relative addresses.
7484 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7485 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7486
7487 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7488 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7489 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7490 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7491 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7492 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7493 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7494 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7495 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7496 @end defmac
7497
7498 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7499 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7500 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7501 the default is zero. Do not define
7502 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7503 @end defmac
7504
7505 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7506 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7507 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7508 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7509 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7510 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7511 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7512 position independent code.
7513 @end defmac
7514
7515 @node Assembler Format
7516 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7517
7518 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7519 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7520 instructions do.
7521
7522 @menu
7523 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7524 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7525 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7526 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7527 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7528 and termination routines.
7529 * Macros for Initialization::
7530 Specific macros that control the handling of
7531 initialization and termination routines.
7532 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7533 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7534 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7535 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7536 @end menu
7537
7538 @node File Framework
7539 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7540 @cindex assembler format
7541 @cindex output of assembler code
7542
7543 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7544 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7545
7546 @findex default_file_start
7547 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7548 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7549 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7550 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7551 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7552 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7553 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7554 @end deftypefn
7555
7556 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7557 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7558 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7559 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7560 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7561 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7562 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7563 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7564
7565 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7566 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7567 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7568 @end deftypevr
7569
7570 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7571 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7572 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7573 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7574 this to be done. The default is false.
7575 @end deftypevr
7576
7577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7578 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7579 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7580 @end deftypefn
7581
7582 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7583 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7584 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7585 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7586 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7587 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7588 this function.
7589 @end deftypefun
7590
7591 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7592 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7593 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7594 nothing.
7595 @end deftypefn
7596
7597 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7598 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7599 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7600 nothing.
7601 @end deftypefn
7602
7603 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7604 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7605 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7606 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7607 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7608 nothing.
7609 @end deftypefn
7610
7611 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7612 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7613 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7614 the end of the line.
7615 @end defmac
7616
7617 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7618 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7619 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7620 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7621 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7622 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7623 @end defmac
7624
7625 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7626 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7627 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7628 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7629 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7630 @end defmac
7631
7632 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7633 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7634 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7635 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7636
7637 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7638 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7639 @end defmac
7640
7641 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7642 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7643
7644 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7645 @end deftypefn
7646
7647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7648 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7649 @end deftypefn
7650
7651 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7652 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7653 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7654 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7655 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7656 of the filename using this macro.
7657 @end defmac
7658
7659 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7660 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7661 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7662 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7663 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7664 this section is associated.
7665 @end deftypefn
7666
7667 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7668 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7669 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
7670 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7671 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
7672 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
7673 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7674 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
7675 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7676 is emitted.
7677 @end deftypefn
7678
7679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7680 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7681 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7682 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7683 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7684 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7685 (from static destructors).
7686 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7687 @end deftypefn
7688
7689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7690 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7691 @end deftypefn
7692
7693 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7694 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7695 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7696 @end deftypevr
7697
7698 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7699 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7700 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7701 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7702 This is true on most ELF targets.
7703 @end deftypevr
7704
7705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7706 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7707 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7708 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7709 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7710
7711 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7712 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7713 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7714 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7715 @end deftypefn
7716
7717 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7718 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7719 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7720 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7721 It can take the following values:
7722
7723 @table @gcctabopt
7724 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7725 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7726
7727 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7728 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7729 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7730 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7731 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7732 various different individual optimization passes.
7733
7734 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7735 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7736 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7737 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7738 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7739 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7740 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7741 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7742 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7743 switches.
7744
7745 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7746 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7747
7748 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7749 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7750 @end table
7751
7752 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7753 supported in the future.
7754
7755 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7756 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7757 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7758 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7759 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7760 hook.
7761 @end deftypefn
7762
7763 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7764 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7765 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7766 hook.
7767 @end deftypevr
7768
7769 @need 2000
7770 @node Data Output
7771 @subsection Output of Data
7772
7773
7774 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7775 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7776 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7777 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7778 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7779 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7780 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7781 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7782 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7783 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7784 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7785 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7786 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7787 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7788
7789 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7790 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7791 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7792 @end deftypevr
7793
7794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7795 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7796 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7797 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7798 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7799 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7800 split the object into smaller parts.
7801
7802 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7803 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7804 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7805 @end deftypefn
7806
7807 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7808 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7809 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7810 @end deftypefn
7811
7812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7813 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7814 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7815 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7816 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7817
7818 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7819 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7820 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7821 return @code{true}.
7822 @end deftypefn
7823
7824 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7825 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7826 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7827 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7828 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7829
7830 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7831 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7832 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7833 @end defmac
7834
7835 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7836 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7837 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7838 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7839 @end defmac
7840
7841 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7842 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7843 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7844 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7845 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7846 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7847 pool before the function.
7848 @end defmac
7849
7850 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7851 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7852 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7853 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7854 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7855 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7856 immediately after this call.
7857
7858 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7859 not be defined.
7860 @end defmac
7861
7862 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7863 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7864 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7865 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7866
7867 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7868 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7869 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7870 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7871 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7872 alignment.
7873
7874 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7875 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7876 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7877 Here is how to do this:
7878
7879 @smallexample
7880 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7881 @end smallexample
7882
7883 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7884 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7885 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7886
7887 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7888 @end defmac
7889
7890 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7891 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7892 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7893 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7894 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7895 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7896
7897 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7898 define this macro.
7899 @end defmac
7900
7901 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7902 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7903 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7904 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7905 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7906
7907 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7908 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7909 @end defmac
7910
7911 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7912 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7913 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7914 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7915 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7916 @end deftypevr
7917
7918 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7919 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7920
7921 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7922 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7923 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7924 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7925 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7926 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7927 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7928 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7929 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7930 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7931 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7932 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7933 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7934 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7935 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7936 on the host machine.
7937
7938 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7939 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7940 machine's memory.
7941 @end defmac
7942
7943 @node Uninitialized Data
7944 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7945
7946 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7947 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7948
7949 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7950 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7951 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7952 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7953 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7954 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7955 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7956 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7957 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7958 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7959 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7960 an ordinary undefined external.
7961
7962 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7963 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7964 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7965
7966 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7967 common global variables are output.
7968 @end defmac
7969
7970 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7971 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7972 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7973 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7974 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7975 as the number of bits.
7976 @end defmac
7977
7978 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7979 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7980 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7981 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7982 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7983 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7984 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7985 @end defmac
7986
7987 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7988 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7989 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7990 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7991 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7992
7993 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7994 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7995 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7996 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7997 the name, and a newline.
7998
7999 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
8000 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8001 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8002 You do not need to do both.
8003
8004 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8005 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8006 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8007 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8008 common in order to save space in the object file.
8009 @end defmac
8010
8011 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8012 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8013 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8014 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8015 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8016
8017 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8018 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8019 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8020
8021 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8022 static variables are output.
8023 @end defmac
8024
8025 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8026 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8027 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8028 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8029 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8030 as the number of bits.
8031 @end defmac
8032
8033 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8034 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8035 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8036 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8037 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8038 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8039 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8040 @end defmac
8041
8042 @node Label Output
8043 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8044
8045 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8046 This is about outputting labels.
8047
8048 @findex assemble_name
8049 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8050 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8051 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8052 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8053 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8054 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8055 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8056 @end defmac
8057
8058 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8059 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8060 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8061 a function.
8062 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8063 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8064 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8065 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8066
8067 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8068 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8069 @end defmac
8070
8071 @findex assemble_name_raw
8072 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8073 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8074 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8075 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8076 that it is more efficient.
8077 @end defmac
8078
8079 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8080 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8081 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8082 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8083 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8084
8085 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8086 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8087 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8088 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8089 define this macro.
8090 @end defmac
8091
8092 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8093 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8094 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8095 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8096 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8097 provided.
8098 @end defmac
8099
8100 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8101 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8102 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8103 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8104 address.
8105
8106 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8107 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8108 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8109 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8110 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8111 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8112 @end defmac
8113
8114 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8115 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8116 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8117 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8118 @samp{.} is used instead.
8119 @end defmac
8120
8121 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8122 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8123 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8124 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8125 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8126 @end defmac
8127
8128 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8129 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8130 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8131 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8132 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8133
8134 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8135 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8136 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8137 types at all, do not define this macro.
8138 @end defmac
8139
8140 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8141 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8142 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8143 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8144 the default is not to define this macro.
8145
8146 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8147 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8148 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8149 types at all, do not define this macro.
8150 @end defmac
8151
8152 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8153 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8154 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8155 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8156 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8157 you should not count on this.
8158
8159 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8160 definition of this macro is provided.
8161 @end defmac
8162
8163 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8164 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8165 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8166 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8167 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8168 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8169 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8170
8171 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8172 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8173
8174 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8175 of this macro.
8176 @end defmac
8177
8178 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8179 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8180 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8181 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8182 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8183 representing the function.
8184
8185 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8186
8187 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8188 of this macro.
8189 @end defmac
8190
8191 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8192 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8193 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8194 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8195 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8196 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8197 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8198
8199 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8200 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8201
8202 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8203 of this macro.
8204 @end defmac
8205
8206 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8207 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8208 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8209 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8210 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8211 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8212
8213 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8214
8215 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8216 of this macro.
8217 @end defmac
8218
8219 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8220 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8221 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8222 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8223 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8224 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8225
8226 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8227 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8228
8229 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8230 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8231 @end defmac
8232
8233 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8234 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8235 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8236 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8237 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8238 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8239 will be an internal label.
8240
8241 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8242 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8243
8244 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8245 @end deftypefn
8246
8247 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8248 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8249 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8250 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8251
8252 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8253 nothing.
8254 @end defmac
8255
8256 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8257 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8258 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8259 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8260 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8261 something about the size of the object.
8262
8263 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8264 nothing.
8265
8266 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8267 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8268 @end defmac
8269
8270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8271 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8272 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8273 that is, available for reference from other files.
8274
8275 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8276 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8277 @end deftypefn
8278
8279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8280 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8281 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8282 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8283
8284 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8285 @end deftypefn
8286
8287 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8288 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8289 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8290 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8291 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8292 @end deftypefn
8293
8294 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8295 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8296 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8297 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8298 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8299 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8300 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8301 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8302
8303 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8304 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8305 macro.
8306 @end defmac
8307
8308 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8309 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8310 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8311 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8312 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8313 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8314 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8315 to make @var{name} weak.
8316 @end defmac
8317
8318 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8319 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8320 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8321 declaration of @code{name}.
8322 @end defmac
8323
8324 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8325 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8326 supports weak symbols.
8327
8328 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8329 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8330 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8331 @end defmac
8332
8333 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8334 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8335
8336 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8337 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8338 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8339 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8340 @end defmac
8341
8342 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8343 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8344 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8345 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8346 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8347 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8348 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8349 @end defmac
8350
8351 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8352 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8353 semantics.
8354
8355 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8356 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8357 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8358 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8359 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8360 be emitted as one-only.
8361 @end defmac
8362
8363 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8364 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8365 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8366 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8367 @end deftypefn
8368
8369 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8370 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8371 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8372 The default is @code{0}.
8373
8374 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8375 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8376 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8377 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8378 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8379 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8380 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8381
8382 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8383 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8384 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8385 table of contents.
8386 @end defmac
8387
8388 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8389 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8390 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8391 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8392 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8393 declaration.
8394
8395 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8396 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8397 @end defmac
8398
8399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8400 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8401 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8402 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8403 @end deftypefn
8404
8405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8406 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8407 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8408 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8409 @end deftypefn
8410
8411 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8412 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8413 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8414 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8415 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8416 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8417 @end defmac
8418
8419 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8420 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8421 @end deftypefn
8422
8423 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8424 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8425 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8426 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8427 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8428 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8429 @end defmac
8430
8431 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8432 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8433 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8434 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8435 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8436 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8437 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8438 being taken.
8439 @end defmac
8440
8441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8442 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8443 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8444
8445 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8446 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8447 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8448
8449 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8450 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8451 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8452 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8453 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8454
8455 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8456 @end deftypefn
8457
8458 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8459 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8460 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8461 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8462 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8463 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8464 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8465 bundles.
8466
8467 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8468 used.
8469 @end defmac
8470
8471 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8472 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8473 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8474
8475 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8476 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8477 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8478
8479 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8480 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8481 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8482 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8483 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8484 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8485 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8486 @end defmac
8487
8488 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8489 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8490 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8491 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8492 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8493
8494 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8495 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8496 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8497 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8498 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8499 internal static variables in different scopes.
8500
8501 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8502 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8503 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8504 between the name and the number will suffice.
8505
8506 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8507 which is correct for most systems.
8508 @end defmac
8509
8510 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8511 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8512 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8513
8514 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8515 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8516 correct for most systems.
8517 @end defmac
8518
8519 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8520 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8521 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8522 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8523 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8524 the tree nodes are available.
8525
8526 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8527 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8528 correct for most systems.
8529 @end defmac
8530
8531 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8532 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8533 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8534 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8535 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8536 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8537 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8538 @end defmac
8539
8540 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8541 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8542 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8543 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8544 an undefined weak symbol.
8545
8546 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8547 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8548 @end defmac
8549
8550 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8551 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8552 Objective-C methods.
8553
8554 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8555 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8556 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8557 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8558
8559 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8560 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8561 systems define other ways of computing names.
8562
8563 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8564 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8565 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8566 50 characters extra.
8567
8568 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8569 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8570 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8571 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8572
8573 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8574 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8575 @end defmac
8576
8577 @node Initialization
8578 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8579 @cindex initialization routines
8580 @cindex termination routines
8581 @cindex constructors, output of
8582 @cindex destructors, output of
8583
8584 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8585 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8586 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8587 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8588 @code{main} is called.
8589
8590 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8591 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8592 terminates.
8593
8594 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8595 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8596 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8597 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8598
8599 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8600 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8601 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8602
8603 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8604 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8605 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8606 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8607 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8608
8609 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8610 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8611 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8612 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8613 pointer containing zero.
8614
8615 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8616 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8617 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8618 list; destructors in forward order.
8619
8620 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8621 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8622 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8623 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8624 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8625 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8626 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8627 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8628
8629 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8630 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8631 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8632 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8633 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8634
8635 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8636 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8637 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8638 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8639 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8640
8641 @smallexample
8642 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8643 @end smallexample
8644
8645 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8646 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8647 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8648 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8649 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8650
8651 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8652 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8653 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8654 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8655 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8656 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8657
8658 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8659 macro properly.
8660
8661 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8662 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8663 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8664 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8665 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8666 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8667
8668 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8669 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8670 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8671 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8672 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8673 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8674 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8675 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8676 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8677 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8678 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8679 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8680 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8681 the initialization process.
8682
8683 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8684 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8685 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8686 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8687 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8688 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8689 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8690 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8691 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8692 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8693 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8694
8695 @ifinfo
8696 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8697 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8698 @end ifinfo
8699
8700 @node Macros for Initialization
8701 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8702
8703 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8704 and termination functions:
8705
8706 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8707 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8708 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8709 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8710 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8711 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8712 run the initialization functions.
8713 @end defmac
8714
8715 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8716 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8717 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8718 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8719 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8720 @end defmac
8721
8722 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8723 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8724 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8725 @end defmac
8726
8727 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8728 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8729 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8730 @end defmac
8731
8732 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8733 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8734 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8735 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8736 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8737 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8738
8739 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8740 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8741 exception tables embedded in the code.
8742 @end defmac
8743
8744 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8745 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8746 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8747 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8748 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8749 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8750 @end defmac
8751
8752 @defmac INVOKE__main
8753 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8754 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8755 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8756 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8757 @end defmac
8758
8759 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8760 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8761 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8762 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8763 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8764 @end defmac
8765
8766 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8767 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8768 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8769 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8770 @end deftypevr
8771
8772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8773 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8774 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8775
8776 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8777 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8778 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8779 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8780
8781 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8782 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8783 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8784 is not defined.
8785 @end deftypefn
8786
8787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8788 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8789 functions rather than initialization functions.
8790 @end deftypefn
8791
8792 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8793 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8794
8795 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8796 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8797 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8798
8799 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8800 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8801
8802 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8803 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8804 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8805 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8806
8807 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8808 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8809 @end defmac
8810
8811 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8812 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8813 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8814 @command{nm}.
8815 @end defmac
8816
8817 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8818 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8819 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8820 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8821 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8822 produces.
8823 @end defmac
8824
8825 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8826 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8827 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8828 termination functions in shared libraries:
8829
8830 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8831 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8832 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8833 @end defmac
8834
8835 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8836 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8837 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8838 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8839 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8840 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8841 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8842 @end defmac
8843
8844 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8845 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8846 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8847 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8848 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8849 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8850 @end defmac
8851
8852 @node Instruction Output
8853 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8854
8855 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8856 This describes assembler instruction output.
8857
8858 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8859 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8860 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8861 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8862 @end defmac
8863
8864 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8865 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8866 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8867 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8868 to registers using alternate names.
8869 @end defmac
8870
8871 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8872 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8873 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8874 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8875 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8876 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8877 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8878 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8879
8880 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8881 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8882 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8883 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8884 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8885 @end defmac
8886
8887 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8888 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8889 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8890
8891 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8892 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8893 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8894 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8895 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8896 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8897 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8898 so that it will not be output twice.
8899
8900 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8901 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8902 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8903 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8904 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8905
8906 @findex recog_data.operand
8907 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8908 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8909
8910 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8911 in the usual way.
8912 @end defmac
8913
8914 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8915 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8916 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8917 they will be output differently.
8918
8919 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8920 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8921 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8922 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8923 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8924 by changing the contents of the vector.
8925
8926 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8927 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8928 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8929 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8930 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8931 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8932
8933 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8934 @end defmac
8935
8936 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8937 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8938 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8939 if necessary.
8940
8941 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8942 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8943 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8944 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8945 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8946 by checking the contents of the vector.
8947 @end deftypefn
8948
8949 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8950 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8951 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8952 RTL expression.
8953
8954 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8955 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8956 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8957 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8958 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8959 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8960 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8961
8962 @findex reg_names
8963 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8964 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8965 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8966 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8967
8968 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8969 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8970 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8971 @var{code}.
8972 @end defmac
8973
8974 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8975 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8976 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8977 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8978 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8979 in this way.
8980 @end defmac
8981
8982 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8983 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8984 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8985 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8986
8987 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8988 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8989 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8990 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8991 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8992 Format}.
8993 @end defmac
8994
8995 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8996 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8997 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8998 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8999 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9000 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9001 or whatever.
9002
9003 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9004 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9005 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9006 @end defmac
9007
9008 @findex final_sequence
9009 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9010 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9011 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9012 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9013 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9014 being output.
9015
9016 @findex asm_fprintf
9017 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9018 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9019 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9020 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9021 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9022 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9023 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9024 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9025 files can define these macros differently.
9026 @end defmac
9027
9028 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9029 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9030 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9031 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9032 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9033 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9034 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9035 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9036 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9037 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9038 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9039 @end defmac
9040
9041 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9042 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9043 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9044 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9045 first variant.
9046
9047 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9048 @smallexample
9049 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9050 @end smallexample
9051 @noindent
9052 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9053 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9054 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9055 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9056 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9057 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9058 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9059 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9060 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9061
9062 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9063 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9064 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9065
9066 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9067 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9068 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9069 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9070 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9071 opcodes or operand order.
9072 @end defmac
9073
9074 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9075 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9076 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9077 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9078 profiling.
9079 @end defmac
9080
9081 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9082 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9083 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9084 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9085 profiling.
9086 @end defmac
9087
9088 @node Dispatch Tables
9089 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9090
9091 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9092 This concerns dispatch tables.
9093
9094 @cindex dispatch table
9095 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9096 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9097 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9098 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9099 definitions of these labels are output using
9100 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9101 way here. For example,
9102
9103 @smallexample
9104 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9105 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9106 @end smallexample
9107
9108 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9109 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9110 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9111 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9112 mode and flags can be read.
9113 @end defmac
9114
9115 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9116 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9117 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9118
9119 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9120 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9121 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9122 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9123 For example,
9124
9125 @smallexample
9126 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9127 @end smallexample
9128 @end defmac
9129
9130 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9131 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9132 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9133 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9134 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9135 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9136
9137 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9138 for the table.
9139
9140 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9141 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9142 @end defmac
9143
9144 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9145 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9146 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9147 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9148 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9149 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9150 of the preceding label.
9151
9152 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9153 the jump-table.
9154 @end defmac
9155
9156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9157 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9158 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9159 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9160 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9161 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9162 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9163 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9164
9165 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9166 @end deftypefn
9167
9168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9169 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9170 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9171 to be broken up according to function.
9172
9173 The default is that no label is emitted.
9174 @end deftypefn
9175
9176 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9177 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9178 @end deftypefn
9179
9180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9181 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9182 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9183 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9184 @end deftypefn
9185
9186 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9187 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9188 @end deftypevr
9189
9190 @node Exception Region Output
9191 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9192
9193 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9194
9195 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9196 region.
9197
9198 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9199 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9200 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9201 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9202 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9203
9204 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9205 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9206 @end defmac
9207
9208 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9209 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9210 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9211 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9212
9213 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9214 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9215 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9216 be marked as not to be collected.
9217 @end defmac
9218
9219 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9220 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9221 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9222 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9223 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9224 @end defmac
9225
9226 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9227 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9228 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9229 @end defmac
9230
9231 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9232 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9233 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9234 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9235 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9236 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9237 @end defmac
9238
9239 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9240 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9241 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9242 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9243 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9244 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9245 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9246
9247 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9248 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9249 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9250
9251 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9252 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9253 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9254 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9255 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9256 depending on this setting.
9257
9258 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9259 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9260 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9261 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9262 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9263 @end deftypefn
9264
9265 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9266 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9267 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9268 command-line option processing.
9269 @end deftypevr
9270
9271 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9272 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9273 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9274 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9275 @end defmac
9276
9277 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9278 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9279 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9280 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9281 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9282 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9283 @end defmac
9284
9285 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9286 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9287 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9288 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9289 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9290 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9291 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9292 @end defmac
9293
9294 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9295 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9296 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9297 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9298 true otherwise.
9299 @end deftypevr
9300
9301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9302 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9303 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9304 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9305 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9306 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9307 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9308 @end deftypefn
9309
9310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9311 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9312 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9313 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9314 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9315 @end deftypefn
9316
9317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9318 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9319 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9320 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9321 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9322 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9323 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9324 @end deftypefn
9325
9326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9327 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9328 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9329 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9330 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9331 @end deftypefn
9332
9333 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9334 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9335 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9336 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9337 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9338 @end deftypevr
9339
9340 @node Alignment Output
9341 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9342
9343 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9344 This describes commands for alignment.
9345
9346 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9347 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9348 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9349
9350 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9351 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9352 define the macro.
9353
9354 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9355 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9356 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9357 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9358 @end defmac
9359
9360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9361 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9362 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9363 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9364 @end deftypefn
9365
9366 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9367 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9368 a @code{BARRIER}.
9369
9370 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9371 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9372 define the macro.
9373 @end defmac
9374
9375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9376 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9377 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9378 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9379 @end deftypefn
9380
9381 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9382 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9383 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9384
9385 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9386 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9387 define the macro.
9388
9389 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9390 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9391 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9392 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9393 @end defmac
9394
9395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9396 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9397 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9398 defined.
9399 @end deftypefn
9400
9401 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9402 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9403 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9404 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9405
9406 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9407 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9408 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9409 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9410 @end defmac
9411
9412 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9413 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9414 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9415 is defined.
9416 @end deftypefn
9417
9418 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9419 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9420 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9421 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9422 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9423 @end defmac
9424
9425 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9426 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9427 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9428 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9429 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9430 section.
9431 @end defmac
9432
9433 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9434 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9435 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9436 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9437 @end defmac
9438
9439 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9440 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9441 for padding, if necessary.
9442 @end defmac
9443
9444 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9445 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9446 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9447 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9448 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9449 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9450 @end defmac
9451
9452 @need 3000
9453 @node Debugging Info
9454 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9455
9456 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9457 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9458
9459 @menu
9460 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9461 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9462 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9463 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9464 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9465 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9466 @end menu
9467
9468 @node All Debuggers
9469 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9470
9471 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9472 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9473
9474 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9475 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9476 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9477 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9478 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9479 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9480 compiler and another for DBX@.
9481
9482 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9483 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9484 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9485 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9486 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9487
9488 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9489 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9490 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9491 @end defmac
9492
9493 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9494 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9495 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9496 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9497 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9498 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9499 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9500 @option{-g} options is used.
9501 @end defmac
9502
9503 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9504 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9505 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9506 @var{offset}.
9507 @end defmac
9508
9509 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9510 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9511 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9512 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9513 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9514 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9515 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9516
9517 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9518 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9519 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9520 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9521 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9522
9523 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9524 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9525 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9526 @end defmac
9527
9528 @node DBX Options
9529 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9530
9531 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9532 These are specific options for DBX output.
9533
9534 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9535 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9536 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9537 @end defmac
9538
9539 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9540 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9541 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9542 @end defmac
9543
9544 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9545 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9546 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9547 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9548 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9549 if there is any occasion to.
9550 @end defmac
9551
9552 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9553 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9554 in the text section.
9555 @end defmac
9556
9557 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9558 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9559 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9560 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9561 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9562 @end defmac
9563
9564 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9565 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9566 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9567 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9568 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9569 information format.
9570 @end defmac
9571
9572 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9573 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9574 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9575 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9576 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9577 @end defmac
9578
9579 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9580 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9581 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9582 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9583 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9584 @end defmac
9585
9586 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9587 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9588 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9589 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9590 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9591 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9592 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9593 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9594 @end defmac
9595
9596 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9597 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9598 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9599 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9600 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9601 if backslash is correct for your system.
9602 @end defmac
9603
9604 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9605 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9606 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9607 variable.
9608 @end defmac
9609
9610 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9611 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9612 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9613 @end defmac
9614
9615 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9616 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9617 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9618 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9619 @end defmac
9620
9621 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9622 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9623 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9624 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9625 @end defmac
9626
9627 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9628 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9629 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9630 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9631 @end defmac
9632
9633 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9634 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9635 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9636 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9637 code.
9638 @end defmac
9639
9640 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9641 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9642 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9643 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9644 an absolute address.
9645 @end defmac
9646
9647 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9648 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9649 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9650 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9651 @end defmac
9652
9653 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9654 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9655 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9656 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9657 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9658 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9659 number for a type number.
9660 @end defmac
9661
9662 @node DBX Hooks
9663 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9664
9665 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9666 These are hooks for DBX format.
9667
9668 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9669 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9670 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9671 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9672 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9673 unique labels in the assembly output.
9674
9675 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9676 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9677 @end defmac
9678
9679 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9680 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9681 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9682 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9683 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9684 @end defmac
9685
9686 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9687 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9688 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9689 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9690 @end defmac
9691
9692 @node File Names and DBX
9693 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9694
9695 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9696 This describes file names in DBX format.
9697
9698 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9699 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9700 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9701 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9702 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9703
9704 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9705 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9706
9707 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9708 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9709 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9710 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9711 @end defmac
9712
9713 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9714 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9715 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9716 the beginning of the file.
9717 @end defmac
9718
9719 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9720 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9721 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9722 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9723 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9724 @end defmac
9725
9726 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9727 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9728 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9729 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9730
9731 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9732 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9733 @end defmac
9734
9735 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9736 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9737 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9738 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9739 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9740 @end defmac
9741
9742 @need 2000
9743 @node SDB and DWARF
9744 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9745
9746 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9747 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9748
9749 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9750 Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9751 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9752 @end defmac
9753
9754 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9755 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9756 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9757
9758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9759 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9760 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9761 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9762 @end deftypefn
9763
9764 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9765 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9766 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9767 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9768 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9769 @end defmac
9770
9771 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9772 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9773 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9774 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9775 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9776 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9777 @end defmac
9778
9779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9780 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9781 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9782 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9783 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9784
9785 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9786 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9787
9788 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9789 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9790 @end deftypefn
9791
9792 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9793 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9794 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9795 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9796 @end defmac
9797
9798 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9799 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9800 @end deftypevr
9801
9802 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9803 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9804 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9805 @end deftypevr
9806
9807 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9808 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9809 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9810 @end deftypevr
9811
9812 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9813 True if register allocation and the passes
9814 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9815 targets.
9816 @end deftypevr
9817
9818 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9819 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9820 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9821 @end defmac
9822
9823 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9824 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9825 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9826 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9827 @end defmac
9828
9829 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
9830 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9831 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
9832 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
9833 given @var{section}.
9834 @end defmac
9835
9836 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9837 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9838 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9839 @end defmac
9840
9841 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9842 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9843 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9844 @end defmac
9845
9846 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9847 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9848 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9849 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9850 is referenced by a function.
9851 @end defmac
9852
9853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9854 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9855 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9856 @end deftypefn
9857
9858 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9859 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9860 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9861 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9862 not define them yourself.
9863 @end defmac
9864
9865 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9866 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9867 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9868 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9869 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9870 required.
9871 @end defmac
9872
9873 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9874 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9875 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9876 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9877 it.
9878 @end defmac
9879
9880 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9881 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9882 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9883 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9884 @end defmac
9885
9886 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9887 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9888 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9889 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9890 @end defmac
9891
9892 @need 2000
9893 @node VMS Debug
9894 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9895
9896 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9897 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9898
9899 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9900 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9901 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9902 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9903 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9904 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9905 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9906 @end defmac
9907
9908 @node Floating Point
9909 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9910 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9911 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9912
9913 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9914 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9915 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9916 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9917 doing the compilation.
9918
9919 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9920 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9921 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9922 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9923 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9924 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9925 target floating point formats are identical.
9926
9927 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9928 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9929 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9930 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9931
9932 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9933 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9934 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9935 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9936 quantity.
9937 @end defmac
9938
9939 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9940 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9941 @end deftypefn
9942
9943 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9944 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9945 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9946 @end deftypefn
9947
9948 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9949 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9950 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9951 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9952 defined by the C language for both.
9953 @end deftypefn
9954
9955 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9956 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9957 @end deftypefn
9958
9959 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9960 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9961 @end deftypefn
9962
9963 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9964 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9965 @end deftypefn
9966
9967 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9968 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9969 @end deftypefn
9970
9971 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9972 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9973 @end deftypefn
9974
9975 @node Mode Switching
9976 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9977 @cindex mode switching
9978 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9979
9980 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9981 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9982 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9983
9984 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9985 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9986 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9987 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9988 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9989 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9990 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9991
9992 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9993 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9994 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9995 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9996 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9997 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9998 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
9999 are optional.
10000 @end defmac
10001
10002 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10003 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10004 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10005 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10006 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10007 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10008 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10009 entity in question.
10010 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10011 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
10012 switch is needed / supplied.
10013 @end defmac
10014
10015 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10016 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10017 @end deftypefn
10018
10019 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10020 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10021 @end deftypefn
10022
10023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10024 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10025 @end deftypefn
10026
10027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10028 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10029 @end deftypefn
10030
10031 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10032 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10033 @end deftypefn
10034
10035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10036 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10037 @end deftypefn
10038
10039 @node Target Attributes
10040 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10041 @cindex target attributes
10042 @cindex machine attributes
10043 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10044
10045 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10046 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10047 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10048
10049 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10050 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10051 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10052 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10053 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10054 take.
10055 @end deftypevr
10056
10057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10058 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10059 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10060 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10061 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10062 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10063 @end deftypefn
10064
10065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10066 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10067 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10068 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10069 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10070 supposed always to be compatible.
10071 @end deftypefn
10072
10073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10074 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10075 the newly defined @var{type}.
10076 @end deftypefn
10077
10078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10079 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10080 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10081 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10082 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10083 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10084 merging.
10085 @end deftypefn
10086
10087 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10088 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10089 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10090 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10091 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10092 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10093 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10094 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10095
10096 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10097 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10098 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10099 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10100 will then define a function called
10101 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10102 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10103 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10104 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10105 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10106 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10107 @end deftypefn
10108
10109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10110 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10111 @end deftypefn
10112
10113 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10114 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10115 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10116 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10117 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10118 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10119 on this implementation detail.
10120 @end defmac
10121
10122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10123 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10124 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10125 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10126 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10127 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10128 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10129 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10130 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10131 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10132 needed.
10133 @end deftypefn
10134
10135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10136 @cindex inlining
10137 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10138 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10139 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10140 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10141 @end deftypefn
10142
10143 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10144 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10145 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10146 These function-specific options may differ
10147 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10148 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10149
10150 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10151 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10152 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10153 @end deftypefn
10154
10155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10156 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10157 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10158 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10159 @xref{Option file format}.
10160 @end deftypefn
10161
10162 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10163 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10164 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10165 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10166 @end deftypefn
10167
10168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10169 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10170 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10171 LTO bytecode.
10172 @end deftypefn
10173
10174 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10175 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10176 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10177 function-specific options.
10178 @end deftypefn
10179
10180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10181 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10182 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10183 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10184 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10185 @end deftypefn
10186
10187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10188 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10189 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10190 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10191 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10192
10193 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10194 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10195
10196 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10197 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10198 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10199 @end deftypefn
10200
10201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10202 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10203 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10204 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10205 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10206 different target machines.
10207 @end deftypefn
10208
10209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10210 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10211 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10212 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10213 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10214 @end deftypefn
10215
10216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10217 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10218 @end deftypefn
10219
10220 @node Emulated TLS
10221 @section Emulating TLS
10222 @cindex Emulated TLS
10223
10224 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10225 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10226 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10227 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10228 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10229 layer.
10230
10231 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10232 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10233 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10234 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10235
10236 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10237 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10238 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10239 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10240 @end deftypevr
10241
10242 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10243 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10244 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10245 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10246 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10247 registration function to be used.
10248 @end deftypevr
10249
10250 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10251 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10252 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10253 any section.
10254 @end deftypevr
10255
10256 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10257 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10258 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10259 section.
10260 @end deftypevr
10261
10262 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10263 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10264 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10265 @end deftypevr
10266
10267 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10268 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10269 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10270 @end deftypevr
10271
10272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10273 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10274 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10275 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10276 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10277 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10278 @end deftypefn
10279
10280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10281 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10282 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10283 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10284 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10285 @end deftypefn
10286
10287 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10288 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10289 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10290 single objects. The default is false.
10291 @end deftypevr
10292
10293 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10294 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10295 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10296 @end deftypevr
10297
10298 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10299 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10300 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10301
10302 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10303 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10304 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10305 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10306
10307 @smallexample
10308 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10309 unsigned int d;
10310
10311 d = cp0count + 3;
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10315 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10316 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10317
10318 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10319 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10320 later in the function.
10321
10322 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10323 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10324 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10325
10326 @node PCH Target
10327 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10328 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10329
10330 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10331 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10332 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10333 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10334 @end deftypefn
10335
10336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10337 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10338 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10339 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10340 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10341
10342 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10343 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10344 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10345 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10346
10347 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10348 suitable for most targets.
10349 @end deftypefn
10350
10351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10352 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10353 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10354 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10355 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10356 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10357 @end deftypefn
10358
10359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10360 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10361 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10362 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10363 to do anything here.
10364 @end deftypefn
10365
10366 @node C++ ABI
10367 @section C++ ABI parameters
10368 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10369
10370 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10371 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10372 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10373 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10374 @end deftypefn
10375
10376 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10377 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10378 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10379 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10380 @end deftypefn
10381
10382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10383 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10384 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10385 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10386 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10387 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10388 @end deftypefn
10389
10390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10391 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10392 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10393 @end deftypefn
10394
10395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10396 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10397 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10398 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10399 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10400 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10401 backend's targeted operating system.
10402 @end deftypefn
10403
10404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10405 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10406 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10407 @code{false}.
10408 @end deftypefn
10409
10410 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10411 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10412 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10413 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10414 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10415 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10416 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10417 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10418 @end deftypefn
10419
10420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10421 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10422 @end deftypefn
10423
10424 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10425 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10426 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10427 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10428 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10429 unit will not be COMDAT.
10430 @end deftypefn
10431
10432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10433 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10434 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10435 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10436 @end deftypefn
10437
10438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10439 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10440 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10441 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10442 @end deftypefn
10443
10444 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10445 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10446 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10447 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10448 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10449 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10450 @end deftypefn
10451
10452 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10453 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10454 @end deftypefn
10455
10456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10457 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10458 @end deftypefn
10459
10460 @node Named Address Spaces
10461 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10462 @cindex named address spaces
10463
10464 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10465 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10466 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10467 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10468 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10469 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10470 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10471 @code{const} type attributes.
10472
10473 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10474 pointers to the generic address space.
10475
10476 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10477 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10478 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10479 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10480 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10481 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10482 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10483 always 32 bits).
10484
10485 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10486 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10487 address space.
10488
10489 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10490 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10491 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10492 named address space #1:
10493 @smallexample
10494 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10495 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10496 @end smallexample
10497
10498 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10499 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10500 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10501 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10502 @end deftypefn
10503
10504 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10505 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10506 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10507 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10508 @end deftypefn
10509
10510 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10511 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10512 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10513 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10514 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10515 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10516 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10517 target hooks for the given address space.
10518 @end deftypefn
10519
10520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10521 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10522 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10523 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10524 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10525 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10526 explicit named address space support.
10527 @end deftypefn
10528
10529 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10530 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10531 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10532 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10533 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10534 @end deftypefn
10535
10536 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10537 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10538 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10539 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10540 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10541 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10542 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10543 @end deftypefn
10544
10545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10546 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10547 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10548 @end deftypefn
10549
10550 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10551 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10552 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10553 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10554 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10555 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10556 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10557 @end deftypefn
10558
10559 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10560 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10561 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10562 @end deftypefn
10563
10564 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10565 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10566 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10567 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10568 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10569 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10570 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10571 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10572 The default implementation does nothing.
10573 @end deftypefn
10574
10575 @node Misc
10576 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10577 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10578
10579 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10580 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10581
10582 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10583 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10584 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10585 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10586 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10587 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10588 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10589 @end defmac
10590
10591 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10592 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10593 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10594 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10595 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10596 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10597 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10598 @end defmac
10599
10600 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10601 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10602 elements of a jump-table should have.
10603 @end defmac
10604
10605 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10606 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10607 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10608 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10609 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10610 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10611 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10612 flags can be updated.
10613 @end defmac
10614
10615 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10616 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10617 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10618 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10619 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10620 is in effect.
10621 @end defmac
10622
10623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10624 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10625 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10626 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10627 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10628 @end deftypefn
10629
10630 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10631 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10632 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10633 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10634 @end defmac
10635
10636 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10637 On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10638 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10639 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10640
10641 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10642 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10643 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
10644
10645 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
10646 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
10647 with a precision lower than the word precision.
10648
10649 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
10650 defined to 1.
10651 @end deftypefn
10652
10653 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10654 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10655 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10656 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10657 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10658 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10659 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10660 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10661
10662 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10663 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10664 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10665 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10666 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10667
10668 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10669 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10670 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10671 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10672 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10673
10674 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10675 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10676 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10677 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10678 @end defmac
10679
10680 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10681 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10682 extends.
10683 @end defmac
10684
10685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10686 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10687 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10688 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10689 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10690 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10691 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10692 @end deftypefn
10693
10694 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10695 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10696 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10697 @end defmac
10698
10699 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10700 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10701 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10702 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10703 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10704 at run-time.
10705 @end defmac
10706
10707 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10708 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10709 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10710 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10711 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10712 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10713 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10714 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10715 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10716 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10717 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10718
10719 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10720 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10721 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10722
10723 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10724 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10725 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10726 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10727 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10728
10729 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10730 @end defmac
10731
10732 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10734 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10735 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10736 @xref{shift patterns}.
10737
10738 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10739 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10740 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10741 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10742 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10743 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10744
10745 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10746 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10747 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10748
10749 The default implementation of this function returns
10750 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10751 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10752 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10753 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10754 by overriding it.
10755 @end deftypefn
10756
10757 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10758 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10759 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10760 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10761 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10762
10763 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10764
10765 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10766 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10767 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10768 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10769 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10770 such cases may improve things.
10771 @end defmac
10772
10773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10774 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10775 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10776 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10777 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10778 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10779 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10780 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10781 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10782 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10783 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10784
10785 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10786 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10787 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10788 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10789
10790 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10791 describe two related properties. If you define
10792 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10793 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10794 extension.
10795
10796 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10797 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10798 @code{mode}.
10799 @end deftypefn
10800
10801 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10802 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10803 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10804 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10805 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10806 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10807
10808 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10809 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10810 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10811 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10812 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10813 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10814 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10815 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10816 the compiler.
10817
10818 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10819 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10820 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10821 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10822 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10823 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10824 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10825 expression
10826
10827 @smallexample
10828 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 @noindent
10832 can be converted to
10833
10834 @smallexample
10835 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10836 @end smallexample
10837
10838 @noindent
10839 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10840 tested into the sign bit.
10841
10842 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10843 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10844 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10845 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10846 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10847 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10848
10849 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10850 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10851 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10852 to be used:
10853
10854 @itemize @bullet
10855 @item
10856 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10857 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10858 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10859 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10860 combine the normalization with other operations.
10861
10862 @item
10863 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10864 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10865 other machines.
10866
10867 @item
10868 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10869 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10870 others.
10871
10872 @item
10873 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10874 @end itemize
10875
10876 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10877 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10878 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10879 those cases, e.g., one matching
10880
10881 @smallexample
10882 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10883 @end smallexample
10884
10885 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10886 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10887 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10888 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10889 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10890 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10891 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10892 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10893
10894 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10895 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10896 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10897 @end defmac
10898
10899 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10900 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10901 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10902 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10903 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10904 this macro.
10905 @end defmac
10906
10907 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10908 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10909 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10910 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10911 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10912 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10913 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10914 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10915 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10916 given mode.
10917 @end defmac
10918
10919 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10920 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10921 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10922 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10923 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10924 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10925 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10926 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10927 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10928 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10929 this value.
10930
10931 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10932 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10933
10934 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10935 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10936 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10937 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10938
10939 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10940 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10941 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10942 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10943 breaking the API@.
10944 @end defmac
10945
10946 @defmac Pmode
10947 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10948 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10949 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10950 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10951 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10952
10953 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10954 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10955 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10956 to @code{Pmode}.
10957 @end defmac
10958
10959 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10960 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10961 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10962 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10963 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10964 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10965 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10966 @end defmac
10967
10968 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10969 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10970 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10971 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10972 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10973 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10974
10975 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10976 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10977 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10978 @end defmac
10979
10980 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10981 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10982
10983 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10984 @end deftypefn
10985
10986 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10987 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10988 @end deftypefn
10989
10990 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10991 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10992 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10993 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10994 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10995 @end defmac
10996
10997 @findex #pragma
10998 @findex pragma
10999 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11000 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11001 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11002 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11003 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
11004 setup required for the pragmas.
11005
11006 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11007 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
11008 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11009
11010 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11011 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11012
11013 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11014 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11015 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11016 @end defmac
11017
11018 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11019 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11020
11021 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11022 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
11023 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11024 pragma of the form
11025
11026 @smallexample
11027 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11028 @end smallexample
11029
11030 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11031 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11032 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11033 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11034 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11035 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11036 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11037 arguments of pragmas registered with
11038 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11039 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11040
11041 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11042 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11043 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11044 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11045 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11046 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11047 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11048 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11049 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11050 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11051 how to build this object file.
11052 @end deftypefun
11053
11054 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11055 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11056 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11057 @end defmac
11058
11059 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11060 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11061 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11062 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11063 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11064 @end defmac
11065
11066 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11067 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11068 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11069 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11070 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11071 @end defmac
11072
11073 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11074 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11075 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11076 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11077 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11078 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11079 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11080 you should define this macro.
11081
11082 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11083 @end defmac
11084
11085 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11086 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11087 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11088 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11089 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11090 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11091 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11092 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11093 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11094 slot of @var{insn}.
11095
11096 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11097 @end defmac
11098
11099 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11100 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11101 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11102 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11103 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11104 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11105
11106 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11107 @end defmac
11108
11109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11110 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11111 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11112 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11113 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11114
11115 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11116 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11117 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11118 @end deftypefn
11119
11120 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11121 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11122 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11123 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11124 separate math library.
11125
11126 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11127 @end defmac
11128
11129 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11130 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11131 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11132
11133 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11134 is wrong.
11135 @end defmac
11136
11137 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11138 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11139 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11140 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11141 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11142 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11143 for cross-profiling.
11144 @end defmac
11145
11146 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11147
11148 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11149 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11150 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11151 1 if it does use cc0.
11152 @end defmac
11153
11154 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11155 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11156 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11157 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11158 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11159 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11160 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11161 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11162 @end defmac
11163
11164 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11165 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11166 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11167 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11168 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11169 @end defmac
11170
11171 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11172 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11173 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11174 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11175 about the currently processed blocks.
11176 @end defmac
11177
11178 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11179 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11180 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11181 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11182 to by @var{ce_info}.
11183 @end defmac
11184
11185 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11186 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11187 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11188 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11189 to by @var{ce_info}.
11190 @end defmac
11191
11192 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11193 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11194 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11195 to by @var{ce_info}.
11196 @end defmac
11197
11198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11199 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11200 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11201 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11202
11203 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11204 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11205 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11206 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11207
11208 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11209 definition is null.
11210 @end deftypefn
11211
11212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11213 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11214 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11215 necessary setup.
11216
11217 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11218 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11219 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11220 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11221
11222 To create a built-in function, call the function
11223 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11224 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11225 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11226 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11227 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11228 @end deftypefn
11229
11230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11231 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11232 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11233 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11234 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11235 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11236 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11237 @code{error_mark_node}.
11238 @end deftypefn
11239
11240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11241
11242 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11243 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11244 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11245 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11246 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11247 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11248 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11249 built-in function.
11250 @end deftypefn
11251
11252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11253 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11254 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11255 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11256 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11257 obtained using this hook:
11258 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11259 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11260 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11261 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11262 @end deftypefn
11263
11264 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11265 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11266 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11267 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11268 @end deftypefn
11269
11270 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11271 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11272 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11273 address @var{loc}.
11274 @end deftypefn
11275
11276 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11277 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11278 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11279 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11280 @end deftypefn
11281
11282 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11283 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11284 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11285 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11286 @end deftypefn
11287
11288 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11289 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11290 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11291 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11292 @end deftypefn
11293
11294 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11295 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11296 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11297 @end deftypefn
11298
11299 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11300 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11301 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11302 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11303 @end deftypefn
11304
11305 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11306 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11307 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11308 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11309 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11310 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11311 @end deftypefn
11312
11313 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11314 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11315 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11316 @end deftypefn
11317
11318 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11319 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11320 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11321 @end deftypefn
11322 @end deftypefn
11323 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11324 Return type to be used for bounds
11325 @end deftypefn
11326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11327 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11328 @end deftypefn
11329 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11330 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11331 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11332 @end deftypefn
11333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11334 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11335 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11336 the number of generated statements.
11337 @end deftypefn
11338
11339 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11340 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11341 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11342 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11343 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11344 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11345 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11346 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11347 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11348 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11349 @end deftypefn
11350
11351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11352 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11353 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11354 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11355 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11356 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11357 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11358 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11359 @end deftypefn
11360
11361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11362 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11363 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11364 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11365 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11366 @end deftypefn
11367
11368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11369 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11370 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11371 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11372 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11373 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11374 the two function decls that will be compared.
11375 @end deftypefn
11376
11377 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11378 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11379 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11380 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11381 identical versions.
11382 @end deftypefn
11383
11384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11385 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11386 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11387 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11388 body must be generated.
11389 @end deftypefn
11390
11391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11392 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11393 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11394 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11395 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11396 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11397 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11398 loop is only entered from the top.
11399
11400 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11401 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11402 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11403 @end deftypefn
11404
11405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11406
11407 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11408 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11409 could not be applied.
11410
11411 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11412 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11413 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11414 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11415 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11416 @end deftypefn
11417
11418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11419 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11420 @end deftypefn
11421
11422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11423 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11424 @end deftypefn
11425
11426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11427 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11428 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11429 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11430 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11431 @end deftypefn
11432
11433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11434
11435 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11436 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11437 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11438 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11439 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11440 that had its initial value copied by using
11441 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11442 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11443 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11444 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11445 @code{MEM}.
11446 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11447 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11448 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11449 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11450 register in question will not be clobbered.
11451 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11452 allocation.
11453 @end deftypefn
11454
11455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11456 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11457 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11458 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11459 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11460 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11461 passed along.
11462 @end deftypefn
11463
11464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11465 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11466 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11467 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11468 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11469 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11470 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11471 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11472 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11473 The default hook function does nothing.
11474
11475 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11476 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11477 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11478 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11479 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11480 outside of any function scope.
11481 @end deftypefn
11482
11483 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11484 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11485 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11486 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11487 @end defmac
11488
11489 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11490 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11491 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11492 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11493 executable files.
11494 @end defmac
11495
11496 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11497 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11498 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11499 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11500 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11501 lists.
11502 @end defmac
11503
11504 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11505 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11506 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11507 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11508 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11509 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11510 defined as this expression:
11511
11512 @smallexample
11513 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11514 build_tree_list
11515 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11516 NULL))
11517 @end smallexample
11518 @end defmac
11519
11520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11521 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11522 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11523 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11524 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11525
11526 @smallexample
11527 static bool
11528 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11529 @{
11530 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11531 @}
11532 @end smallexample
11533 @end deftypefn
11534
11535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11536 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11537 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11538 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11539 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11540 to inter-block scheduling.
11541 @end deftypefn
11542
11543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11544 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11545 registers
11546 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11547 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11548 that all target registers in the class returned by
11549 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11550 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11551 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11552 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11553 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11554 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11555 @end deftypefn
11556
11557 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11558 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11559 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11560 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11561 @end deftypefn
11562
11563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11564 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11565 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11566 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11567 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11568 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11569 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11570 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11571 @end deftypefn
11572
11573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11574 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11575 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11576 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11577 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11578 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11579 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11580 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11581 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11582 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11583 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11584 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11585 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11586 @end deftypefn
11587
11588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11589 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11590 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11591 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11592 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11593 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11594 number of memory accesses.
11595 @end deftypefn
11596
11597 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11598 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11599 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11600 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11601 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11602 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11603 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11604 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11605 @end defmac
11606
11607 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11608 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11609 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11610 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11611 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11612 @end deftypefn
11613
11614 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11615 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11616 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11617 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11618 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11619 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11620 @end deftypefn
11621
11622 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11623 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11624 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11625 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11626 that are different from @option{-I}.
11627 @end deftypefn
11628
11629 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11630 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11631 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11632 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11633 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11634 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11635 @end defmac
11636
11637 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11638 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11639 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11640 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11641 @end defmac
11642
11643 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11644 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11645 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11646 @end defmac
11647
11648 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11649 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11650 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11651 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11652 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11653 @end defmac
11654
11655 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11656 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11657 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11658 @end defmac
11659
11660 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11661 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11662 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11663 and scanf formatter settings.
11664 @end defmac
11665
11666 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11667 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11668 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11669 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11670 @end deftypefn
11671
11672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11673 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11674 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11675 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11676 @end deftypefn
11677
11678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11679 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11680 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11681 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11682 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11683 @end deftypefn
11684
11685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11686 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11687 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11688 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11689 the front end.
11690 @end deftypefn
11691
11692 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11693 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11694 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11695 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11696 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11697 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11698 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11699 @end deftypefn
11700
11701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11702 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11703 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11704 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11705 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11706 conversion rules.
11707 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11708 @end deftypefn
11709
11710 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11711 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11712 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11713 @end defmac
11714
11715 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11716 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11717 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11718 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11719 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11720 @end defmac
11721
11722 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11723 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11724 necessary.
11725 @end deftypefn
11726
11727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11728 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11729 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11730 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11731 is needed.
11732 @end deftypefn
11733
11734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11735 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11736 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11737 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11738 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11739 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11740 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11741 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11742 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11743 @end deftypefn
11744
11745 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11746 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11747 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11748 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11749 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11750 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11751 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11752 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11753 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11754 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11755 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11756 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11757 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11758 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11759 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11760 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11761 @end deftypevr
11762
11763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11764 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11765 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11766 supported by the target.
11767 @end deftypefn
11768
11769 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11770 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11771 memory model bits are allowed.
11772 @end deftypefn
11773
11774 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11775 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11776 @end deftypevr
11777
11778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11779 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11780 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11781 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11782 @end deftypefn
11783
11784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11785 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11786 @end deftypefn
11787
11788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11789 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11790 @end deftypefn
11791
11792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11793 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11794 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11795 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11796 @end deftypefn
11797
11798 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11799 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11800 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11801 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11802 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11803 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11804
11805 @end deftypefn
11806
11807 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11808
11809 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11810 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11811 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11812 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11813 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11814 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11815 representation.
11816
11817 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11818 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11819 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11820 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11821 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11822
11823 @itemize @bullet
11824 @item
11825 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11826 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11827 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11828
11829 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11830 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11831 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11832 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11833 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11834 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11835 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11836 not really a large change.
11837
11838 @item
11839 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11840 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11841 port in this code.
11842
11843 @item
11844 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11845 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11846 @end itemize
11847
11848 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11849 maintainer is familiar with.
11850
11851 @end defmac
11852
11853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
11854 If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
11855 @end deftypefn